]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
dbxout.c (dbxout_symbol_location): Pass new argument to alter_subreg.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
c58b209a 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
ee3d2ecd 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
66647d44 3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
feca2ed3
JW
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
672a6f42 8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
feca2ed3
JW
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
672a6f42
NB
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
648c546a 22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
672a6f42
NB
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
feca2ed3
JW
27
28@menu
648c546a 29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
feca2ed3 30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
630d3d5a 31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
414c4dc4 32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
feca2ed3
JW
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
f38840db 37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
feca2ed3 38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
6ccde948 39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
feca2ed3
JW
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
aacd3885 43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
feca2ed3
JW
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
c237e94a 46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
feca2ed3 47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
6ccde948 48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
feca2ed3
JW
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
b216cd4a 51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
9f09b1f2 52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
91d231cb 53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
feb60f03 54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
d604bca3 55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7bb1ad93 56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
4185ae53 57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
09e881c9 58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
feca2ed3
JW
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
672a6f42 62@node Target Structure
648c546a 63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
672a6f42
NB
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
f6897b10
SS
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
672a6f42
NB
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
91d231cb
JM
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
672a6f42 83
f6897b10 84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
672a6f42
NB
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
648c546a 89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
672a6f42
NB
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
648c546a 92@code{targetm} structure.
672a6f42 93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
feca2ed3
JW
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
a2c4f8e0 120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
db36994b
RS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
3bd6d4c4
AO
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
db36994b
RS
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 136@end defmac
db36994b 137
a2c4f8e0 138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7816bea0
DJ
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 155@end defmac
7816bea0 156
a2c4f8e0 157@defmac CPP_SPEC
a3a15b4d 158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
161d7b59
JM
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
feca2ed3
JW
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 163@end defmac
feca2ed3 164
a2c4f8e0 165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
a9374841 166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
161d7b59 167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
a9374841 168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
a2c4f8e0 169@end defmac
a9374841 170
a2c4f8e0 171@defmac CC1_SPEC
a3a15b4d 172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
66519c70
JL
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
a3a15b4d 175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
630d3d5a 176for GCC to pass to front ends.
feca2ed3
JW
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 179@end defmac
feca2ed3 180
a2c4f8e0 181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
a3a15b4d 182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
feca2ed3
JW
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
1d96e5b4
FF
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
161d7b59 189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 190@end defmac
feca2ed3 191
a2c4f8e0 192@defmac ASM_SPEC
a3a15b4d 193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
a3a15b4d 195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
feca2ed3
JW
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 199@end defmac
feca2ed3 200
a2c4f8e0 201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
a3a15b4d 202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
feca2ed3
JW
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 208@end defmac
feca2ed3 209
a2c4f8e0 210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
4977bab6
ZW
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
a2c4f8e0 221@end defmac
4977bab6 222
a2c4f8e0 223@defmac LINK_SPEC
a3a15b4d 224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
feca2ed3
JW
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 229@end defmac
feca2ed3 230
a2c4f8e0 231@defmac LIB_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 238@end defmac
feca2ed3 239
a2c4f8e0 240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
a3a15b4d 241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
feca2ed3
JW
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
a3a15b4d 246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
630d3d5a 247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
a2c4f8e0 248@end defmac
feca2ed3 249
328163dc
MA
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
4ec7afd7
KH
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
328163dc
MA
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
743eeb5a
AM
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
a2c4f8e0 277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 284@end defmac
feca2ed3 285
a2c4f8e0 286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 292@end defmac
feca2ed3 293
a2c4f8e0 294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
008355a6
AO
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
a2c4f8e0 302@end defmac
008355a6 303
a2c4f8e0 304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
a2c4f8e0 308@end defmac
e7f13528 309
a2c4f8e0 310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
f4314bb6 313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
e7f13528 314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
a2c4f8e0 315@end defmac
e7f13528 316
a2c4f8e0 317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
feca2ed3
JW
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
630d3d5a 329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
feca2ed3
JW
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
3ab51846 340@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
3ab51846 345@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
50d440bc
NC
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
feca2ed3
JW
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 367@end defmac
feca2ed3 368
a2c4f8e0 369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
feca2ed3
JW
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
630d3d5a 372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
a2c4f8e0 373@end defmac
feca2ed3 374
a2c4f8e0 375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
bbd7687d
DM
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
a2c4f8e0 378@end defmac
bbd7687d 379
a2c4f8e0 380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9ec36da5
JL
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
bbd7687d
DM
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
a2c4f8e0 388@end defmac
9ec36da5 389
c49a6962
JM
390@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
392@end deftypevr
393
a2c4f8e0 394@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3
JW
395Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403@xref{Target Fragment}.
a2c4f8e0 404@end defmac
feca2ed3 405
a2c4f8e0 406@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
05739753 407Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
630d3d5a 408a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
feca2ed3 409indicates an absolute file name.
a2c4f8e0 410@end defmac
feca2ed3 411
a2c4f8e0 412@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
413If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
414@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
1401cf37 415when the compiler is built as a cross
5505263f
JL
416compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
417to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
a2c4f8e0 418@end defmac
feca2ed3 419
a2c4f8e0 420@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3 421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
0d037580 422standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
feca2ed3 423try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
0d037580
DJ
424@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
425is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 426@end defmac
feca2ed3 427
656c7a3a
AL
428@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
429Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
431when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
433is built as a cross compiler.
434@end defmac
435
436@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
437Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
438standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
439default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
440@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
441is built as a cross compiler.
442@end defmac
443
a2c4f8e0 444@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
445If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
446standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
1401cf37 447compiler is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 448@end defmac
feca2ed3 449
a2c4f8e0 450@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
feca2ed3 451If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
1401cf37
MLI
452standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
453cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 454@end defmac
feca2ed3 455
a2c4f8e0 456@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
e9a25f70 457Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
feca2ed3
JW
458variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
459loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
460initialize the necessary environment variables.
a2c4f8e0 461@end defmac
feca2ed3 462
a2c4f8e0 463@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
464Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
465standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
466try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
467comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
468@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
feca2ed3 469
c237e94a
ZW
470Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
471replacement.
a2c4f8e0 472@end defmac
feca2ed3 473
08b2bad2
SB
474@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
475The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
e9a25f70
JL
476See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
477If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
a2c4f8e0 478@end defmac
e9a25f70 479
a2c4f8e0 480@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3 481Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
e9a25f70
JL
482for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
483usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
484@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
485@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
feca2ed3 486and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
161d7b59 487and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
feca2ed3
JW
488@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
489
490The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
e9a25f70 491Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
9f6dc500
HPN
492string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
493for C++-only directories,
e9a25f70
JL
494and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
495wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
496the array with a null element.
497
498The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
4bd0bee9 499if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
9f6dc500 500or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
e9a25f70
JL
501operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
502
e9a25f70 503For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
feca2ed3 504
3ab51846 505@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
506#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
507@{ \
e9a25f70
JL
508 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
509 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
511 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
feca2ed3 513@}
3ab51846 514@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 515@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
516
517Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
518
519@enumerate
520@item
630d3d5a 521Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
522
523@item
fe037b8a 524The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 525is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
fe037b8a 526@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
feca2ed3
JW
527
528@item
529The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
530
531@item
fe037b8a 532The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 533in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
feca2ed3
JW
534
535@item
ff2ce160 536The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
537
538@item
ff2ce160 539The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
fe037b8a
CD
540
541@item
ff2ce160 542The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 543compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
544@end enumerate
545
546Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
547
548@enumerate
549@item
630d3d5a 550Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
551
552@item
fe037b8a
CD
553The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
554value based on the installed toolchain location.
feca2ed3
JW
555
556@item
557The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
512b62fb 558(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
feca2ed3
JW
559
560@item
fe037b8a 561The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 562in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
563
564@item
fe037b8a
CD
565The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
566
567@item
ff2ce160 568The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 569compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
570
571@item
ff2ce160 572The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 573native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
574
575@item
ff2ce160 576The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 577native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
578
579@item
fe037b8a
CD
580The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
581If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
582the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
feca2ed3
JW
583
584@item
fe037b8a
CD
585The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
586compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
587@file{/lib/}.
588
589@item
fe037b8a
CD
590The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
591compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
592@file{/usr/lib/}.
593@end enumerate
594
595@node Run-time Target
596@section Run-time Target Specification
597@cindex run-time target specification
598@cindex predefined macros
599@cindex target specifications
600
601@c prevent bad page break with this line
602Here are run-time target specifications.
603
a2c4f8e0 604@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22 605This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
44082375 606built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
1f95326c 607the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
cb60f38d 608@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
12a41c22
NB
609calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
610finished command line option processing your code can use those
611results freely.
3df89291
NB
612
613@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
614command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
d90a95fb 615the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
3df89291
NB
616accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
617
d90a95fb 618@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
3df89291 619object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
d90a95fb 620@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
3df89291
NB
621defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
622with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
623only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
624example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
625and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
626@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
627defines only @code{_ABI64}.
628
e0322d5c
NB
629You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
630@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
631or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
632assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
633macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
ce3649d2 634to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
c219e1da
JDA
635variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
636@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
637preprocessing.
a2c4f8e0 638@end defmac
e0322d5c 639
a2c4f8e0 640@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22
NB
641Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
642and is used for the target operating system instead.
a2c4f8e0 643@end defmac
12a41c22 644
a2c4f8e0 645@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
4e2e315f
NB
646Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
647and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
648macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
649it yourself.
a2c4f8e0 650@end defmac
4e2e315f 651
a2c4f8e0 652@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
75685792
RS
653This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
654any target-specific headers.
a2c4f8e0 655@end deftypevar
feca2ed3 656
677f3fa8 657@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
75685792
RS
658This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
659Its default setting is 0.
9e3be889 660@end deftypevr
75685792 661
bacf5b96
RS
662@cindex optional hardware or system features
663@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
664
677f3fa8 665@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
75685792
RS
666This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
667target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
668(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
669processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
670definition does nothing but return true.
671
96e45421
JM
672@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
673@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
674storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
675option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
676via attributes).
75685792
RS
677@end deftypefn
678
acce4e77 679@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
1f1d5130
MS
680This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
681target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
682definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
683option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
7a241624
JR
684valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
685default definition does nothing but return false.
1f1d5130
MS
686
687In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
688options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
689only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
690should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
691@end deftypefn
692
acce4e77 693@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
91ebb981
IS
694Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
695@end deftypefn
696
70f42967
SB
697@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
698Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
699@end deftypefn
700
701@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
702Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
703@end deftypefn
704
acce4e77 705@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
91ebb981
IS
706If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
707@end deftypefn
708
acce4e77 709@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
91ebb981 710If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
26705988
IS
711@end deftypefn
712
2b7e2984 713@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
74f7912a 714This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
2b7e2984
SE
715but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
716pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
717attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
74f7912a
JR
718when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
719actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
2b7e2984
SE
720@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
721@end deftypefn
722
c7b5e395 723@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
724This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
725but is only used in the C
c7b5e395
GK
726language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
727used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
728frontends.
729@end defmac
730
677f3fa8 731@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
feca2ed3 732Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
733various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
734options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
735options are processed once
feca2ed3 736just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 737of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 738options passed explicitly.
feca2ed3 739
3020190e 740This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a51fa0f4
MM
741options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
742@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 743@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 744
677f3fa8 745@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7e4aae92
JM
746Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
747@end deftypefn
748
4c77620d 749@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
128dc8e2
JM
750Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
751@end deftypefn
752
3bd36029
RS
753@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
754Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
755during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
756the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
757can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
758and @code{nomips16} attributes.
759
760Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
761registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
762operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
763in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
764significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
765for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
766switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
767
768Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
769is 0.
770@end defmac
771
414c4dc4
NC
772@node Per-Function Data
773@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
774@cindex per-function data
775@cindex data structures
776
777If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
778provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
779using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
780nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
781when another one comes along.
782
783GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
784contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
785structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
786@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
787to their own specific data.
788
789If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
e2500fed
GK
790@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
791This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
792@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
414c4dc4
NC
793
794One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
795RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
796RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
797function, for level 0.
798
aee96fe9 799Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
414c4dc4
NC
800all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
801function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
802stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
803stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
02f52e19 804@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
414c4dc4
NC
805the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
806single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
807longer supported.
808
a2c4f8e0 809@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
c21cd8b1 810Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
414c4dc4 811is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
c21cd8b1 812The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
813function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
814@end defmac
414c4dc4 815
a2c4f8e0
ZW
816@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
817If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
818function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
819target to perform any target specific initialization of the
820@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
821used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
414c4dc4 822
8a36672b 823@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
e2500fed 824Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
a9429e29 825GC allocation, including the structure itself.
a2c4f8e0 826@end deftypevar
414c4dc4 827
feca2ed3
JW
828@node Storage Layout
829@section Storage Layout
830@cindex storage layout
831
832Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
833alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
834expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
835@xref{Run-time Target}.
836
a2c4f8e0 837@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
838Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
839byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
840This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
841bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
842be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
843macro need not be a constant.
844
845This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
846bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
a2c4f8e0 847@end defmac
feca2ed3 848
a2c4f8e0 849@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
850Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
851word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 852@end defmac
feca2ed3 853
a2c4f8e0 854@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
855Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
856most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
857memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
858order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
feca2ed3 859macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 860@end defmac
feca2ed3 861
c0a6a1ef
BS
862@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
863On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
864registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
865the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
866the order of words in memory.
867@end defmac
868
a2c4f8e0 869@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
870Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
871@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
872containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
873have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
874
875You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
876multi-word integers.
a2c4f8e0 877@end defmac
feca2ed3 878
a2c4f8e0 879@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
feca2ed3 880Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
5c60f03d 881unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
a2c4f8e0 882@end defmac
feca2ed3 883
a2c4f8e0 884@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
e81dd381
KG
885Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
886is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 887@end defmac
feca2ed3 888
a2c4f8e0 889@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
890Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
891@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
892largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 893@end defmac
feca2ed3 894
a2c4f8e0 895@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
c4336539
PB
896Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
897register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
a2c4f8e0 898@end defmac
feca2ed3 899
a2c4f8e0 900@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
901Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
902@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
903smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 904@end defmac
feca2ed3 905
a2c4f8e0 906@defmac POINTER_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
907Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
908width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
2465bf76
KG
909you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
910a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 911@end defmac
feca2ed3 912
a2c4f8e0 913@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4923a230
RS
914A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
915@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
916greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
917should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
918is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
919@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
920
921You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
922and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
a2c4f8e0 923@end defmac
feca2ed3 924
a2c4f8e0 925@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
926A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
927is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
928stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
929scalar type.
930
931On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
932register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
933@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
934cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
935floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
936counterparts.
937
938For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
939However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
940either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
941the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
942sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
943@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
944
945Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
a2c4f8e0 946@end defmac
feca2ed3 947
9ddb66ef 948@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
cde0f3fd
PB
949Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
950function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
951and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
952change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
953pointer} types.
954
666e3ceb
PB
955@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
956return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
957@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
958If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
959which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
960then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
961the signedness may be different.
962
5e617be8
AK
963@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
964
cde0f3fd
PB
965The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
966also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
967if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
61f71b34 968@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 969
a2c4f8e0 970@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
971Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
972bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
973regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
974size of an integer.
a2c4f8e0 975@end defmac
feca2ed3 976
a2c4f8e0 977@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
978Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
979stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
980desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
981if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
982this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 983@end defmac
c795bca9 984
a2c4f8e0 985@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
986Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
987stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
988is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
989macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
990@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 991@end defmac
feca2ed3 992
2e3f842f
L
993@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
994Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
995from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
996to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997@end defmac
998
a2c4f8e0 999@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3 1000Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
a2c4f8e0 1001@end defmac
feca2ed3 1002
a2c4f8e0 1003@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
c4f46fde
DD
1004Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1005bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1006just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
a2c4f8e0 1007@end defmac
feca2ed3 1008
95331614
OH
1009@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1010Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1011provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1012@end defmac
1013
6e4f1168
L
1014@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1015Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1016not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1017@end defmac
1018
a2c4f8e0 1019@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
861bb6c1
JL
1020If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1021object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1022nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1023on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
a2c4f8e0 1024@end defmac
861bb6c1 1025
a2c4f8e0 1026@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
11cf4d18
JJ
1027Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1028machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1029structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1030by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1031@end defmac
feca2ed3 1032
a2c4f8e0 1033@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
feca2ed3 1034An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
ad9335eb
JJ
1035alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1036@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1037alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1038field alignment has not been set by the
1039@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1040@end defmac
feca2ed3 1041
2e3f842f
L
1042@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1043Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1044to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1045
1046If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1047
1048@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1049@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1050@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1051@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1052@end defmac
1053
a2c4f8e0 1054@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1055Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1056Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1057@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1058the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
11d90e2d
CD
1059
1060On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1061the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1062a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1063On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1064@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
a2c4f8e0 1065@end defmac
feca2ed3 1066
a2c4f8e0 1067@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1068If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
8a198bd2
JW
1069the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1070the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
feca2ed3
JW
1071macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1072
1073If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075@findex strcpy
1076One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1077make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1078arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079constants to character arrays can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1080@end defmac
feca2ed3 1081
a2c4f8e0 1082@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
feca2ed3
JW
1083If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1084that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1085@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1086have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1087align the object.
1088
1089If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1092constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093constants can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1094@end defmac
feca2ed3 1095
a2c4f8e0 1096@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1097If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
d16790f2
JW
1098the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1099the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1100macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1101
1102If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103
1104One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1105make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1106
64ad7c99 1107If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 1108@end defmac
d16790f2 1109
5aea1e76
UW
1110@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1111This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1112@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1113require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1114this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1115the vector element type.
1116@end deftypefn
1117
76fe54f0
L
1118@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1119If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1120@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1121and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1122have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1123align the slot.
1124
1125If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1126@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1127be used.
1128
1129This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1130of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1131
64ad7c99 1132If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76fe54f0
L
1133@end defmac
1134
9bfaf89d
JJ
1135@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1136If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1137variable @var{decl}.
1138
1139If this macro is not defined, then
1140@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1141is used.
1142
1143One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1144make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1145
64ad7c99 1146If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
9bfaf89d
JJ
1147@end defmac
1148
ae58e548
JJ
1149@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1150If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1151for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1152@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1153
1154If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1155@end defmac
1156
a2c4f8e0 1157@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
c771326b 1158Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
feca2ed3
JW
1159empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1160
78d55cc8 1161If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1162@end defmac
feca2ed3 1163
a2c4f8e0 1164@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
1165Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1166Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1167
1168If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1169@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1170@end defmac
feca2ed3 1171
a2c4f8e0 1172@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1173Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1174if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1175go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
a2c4f8e0 1176@end defmac
feca2ed3 1177
a2c4f8e0 1178@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
feca2ed3 1179Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
c771326b 1180alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
feca2ed3 1181
8dc65b6e
MM
1182The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1183@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1184structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1185that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1186that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1187
1188Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1189@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1190four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1191not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1192
1193An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1194structure.
feca2ed3
JW
1195
1196If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1197a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1198
1199Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
c771326b 1200bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
feca2ed3
JW
1201support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1202@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1203
c771326b 1204The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
feca2ed3
JW
1205@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1206Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1207
c771326b 1208Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
feca2ed3
JW
1209@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1210@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1211
a3a15b4d 1212If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
c771326b 1213bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
feca2ed3
JW
1214what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1215
3ab51846 1216@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1217struct foo1
1218@{
1219 char x;
1220 char :0;
1221 char y;
1222@};
1223
1224struct foo2
1225@{
1226 char x;
1227 int :0;
1228 char y;
1229@};
1230
1231main ()
1232@{
1233 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1234 sizeof (struct foo1));
1235 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1236 sizeof (struct foo2));
1237 exit (0);
1238@}
3ab51846 1239@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1240
1241If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1242get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1243@end defmac
feca2ed3 1244
a2c4f8e0 1245@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f913c102
AO
1246Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1247to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
a2c4f8e0 1248@end defmac
feca2ed3 1249
b5bde9ff 1250@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
13c1cd82
PB
1251When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1252whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1253structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1254the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1255@end deftypefn
1256
b5bde9ff 1257@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
c2a64439
PB
1258This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1259should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1260these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1261
1262The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1263@end deftypefn
1264
d9886a9e
L
1265@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1266Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1267be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
9f6dc500 1268
182e515e
AH
1269If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1270mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1271case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1272retain the field's mode.
1273
8d8da227 1274Normally, this is not needed.
d9886a9e 1275@end deftypefn
9f6dc500 1276
a2c4f8e0 1277@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
0003feb2
VM
1278Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1279by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1280way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
feca2ed3
JW
1281@var{specified}.
1282
1283The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1284the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
a2c4f8e0 1285@end defmac
feca2ed3 1286
a2c4f8e0 1287@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1288An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1289machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1290this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1291appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1292(DImode)} is assumed.
a2c4f8e0 1293@end defmac
feca2ed3 1294
a2c4f8e0 1295@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
73c8090f 1296If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1297specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1298@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1299@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1300@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1301having its mode specified.
73c8090f
DE
1302
1303You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1304would most commonly define this macro if the
1305@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
130664-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1307@end defmac
73c8090f 1308
a2c4f8e0 1309@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
39403d82
DE
1310If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1311specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1312@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1313
1314You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1315You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1316pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1317@end defmac
39403d82 1318
9ddb66ef 1319@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1320This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1321of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323targets.
1324@end deftypefn
1325
9ddb66ef 1326@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1327This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1328of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1329@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1330targets.
1331@end deftypefn
1332
8a9a2486
JR
1333@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1334Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1335The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1336@end deftypefn
1337
a2c4f8e0 1338@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
3fcaac1d 1339If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
4099e2c2 1340mode is towards zero.
3fcaac1d 1341
4099e2c2
UW
1342Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343floating-point arithmetic.
3fcaac1d
RS
1344
1345Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
a2c4f8e0 1346@end defmac
3fcaac1d 1347
a2c4f8e0 1348@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
4226378a 1349This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
3fcaac1d
RS
1350bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1351exponent for normal numbers instead.
1352
4099e2c2 1353Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
3fcaac1d
RS
1354floating-point arithmetic.
1355
1356The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
a2c4f8e0 1357@end defmac
feca2ed3 1358
9ddb66ef 1359@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f913c102
AO
1360This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1361@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1362Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1363unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1364different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1365alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1366bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1367the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1368(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
6335b0aa 1369another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f913c102 1370other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
e4850f36
DR
1371
1372When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1373of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1374bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1375and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8a36672b
JM
1376chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1377size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
e4850f36
DR
1378alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1379
1380If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8a36672b 1381the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
e4850f36
DR
1382used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1383precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1384may affect its placement.
f913c102
AO
1385@end deftypefn
1386
9ddb66ef 1387@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9a8ce21f 1388Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
9a8ce21f
JG
1389@end deftypefn
1390
9ddb66ef 1391@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
ab22c1fa
CF
1392Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1393@end deftypefn
1394
e41b2a33
PB
1395@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1396This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1397to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1398For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1399for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1400registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1401usage.
1402@end deftypefn
1403
1404@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1405This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1406that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1407@end deftypefn
1408
9ddb66ef 1409@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
608063c3
JB
1410If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1411uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1412to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1413mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1414the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1415not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1416for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1417return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1418string constant.
f18eca82
ZL
1419
1420Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1421qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1422fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1423is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1424length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1425ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1426@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1427@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1428code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1429@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1430codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1431spaces in your string.
1432
608063c3
JB
1433This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1434name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1435can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1436before mangling.
1437
f18eca82
ZL
1438The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1439appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1440types.
1441@end deftypefn
1442
feca2ed3
JW
1443@node Type Layout
1444@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1445
1446These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1447basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1448the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1449languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1450
a2c4f8e0 1451@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1452A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1453target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1454@end defmac
feca2ed3 1455
a2c4f8e0 1456@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1457A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1458target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1459(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1460unit.)
a2c4f8e0 1461@end defmac
feca2ed3 1462
a2c4f8e0 1463@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1464A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1465target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1466@end defmac
feca2ed3 1467
a2c4f8e0 1468@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1615c261 1469On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
8a36672b 1470@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1615c261
RK
1471that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1472the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1473value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1474@end defmac
1615c261 1475
a2c4f8e0 1476@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1477A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1478target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
047c1c92 1479words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
feca2ed3 1480macro must be at least 64.
a2c4f8e0 1481@end defmac
feca2ed3 1482
a2c4f8e0 1483@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3 1484A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
c294bd99
HPN
1485target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1486@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1487@end defmac
feca2ed3 1488
a2c4f8e0 1489@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
3d1ad9e5
JM
1490A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1491C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1492this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1493@end defmac
68eb4fb9 1494
a2c4f8e0 1495@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1496A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1497target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1498@end defmac
feca2ed3 1499
a2c4f8e0 1500@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1501A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1502target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503words.
a2c4f8e0 1504@end defmac
feca2ed3 1505
a2c4f8e0 1506@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1507A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1508the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509words.
a2c4f8e0 1510@end defmac
feca2ed3 1511
325217ed
CF
1512@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1514the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516@end defmac
1517
1518@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1520the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1526the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528@end defmac
1529
1530@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1532the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534@end defmac
1535
1536@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1538the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1540@end defmac
1541
1542@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1544the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1546@end defmac
1547
1548@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1550the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1556the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1558@end defmac
1559
4e9db8b2
SE
1560@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1561Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1562if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1563@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1564default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1565@end defmac
1566
1567@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1568Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
4e9db8b2
SE
1569@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1570@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1571anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
4e9db8b2
SE
1572or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1573otherwise it is 0.
1574@end defmac
1575
1576@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
083cad55 1577Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
4e9db8b2
SE
1578@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581@end defmac
1582
1583@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
083cad55 1584Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
4e9db8b2
SE
1585@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1586anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1587is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1588@end defmac
1589
cdbf4541
BS
1590@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1591This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1592hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1593causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1594prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1595uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1596the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1597@end defmac
1598
4a73d865
JM
1599@defmac SF_SIZE
1600@defmacx DF_SIZE
1601@defmacx XF_SIZE
1602@defmacx TF_SIZE
1603Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1604@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1605if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1606@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1607for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1608@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1609@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
4a73d865
JM
1610@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1611@end defmac
1612
a2c4f8e0 1613@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
d57a4b98
RH
1614A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1615assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1616default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1617@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
a2c4f8e0 1618@end defmac
aaa2e8ef 1619
a2c4f8e0 1620@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
e9a25f70
JL
1621A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1622supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1623value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1624If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1625is the default.
a2c4f8e0 1626@end defmac
e9a25f70 1627
a2c4f8e0 1628@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
1629An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1630@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
630d3d5a
JM
1631always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1632and @option{-funsigned-char}.
a2c4f8e0 1633@end defmac
feca2ed3 1634
221ee7c9
KH
1635@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1636This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1637@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1638of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
35afa569
KH
1639@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1640
221ee7c9
KH
1641The default is to return false.
1642@end deftypefn
35afa569 1643
a2c4f8e0 1644@defmac SIZE_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1645A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1646for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1647contents of the string.
1648
1649The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1650spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1651appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1652of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1653@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1654You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1655compiler to crash on startup.
feca2ed3
JW
1656
1657If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1658int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1659@end defmac
feca2ed3 1660
18dae016
TG
1661@defmac SIZETYPE
1662GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1663@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1664dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1665the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1666is extracted.
1667
1668The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1671@end defmac
1672
a2c4f8e0 1673@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1674A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1675for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1676@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1677@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1680@end defmac
feca2ed3 1681
a2c4f8e0 1682@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1683A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1684for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1685the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1686information.
1687
1688If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1689@end defmac
feca2ed3 1690
a2c4f8e0 1691@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1692A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1693characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1694@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
a2c4f8e0 1695@end defmac
feca2ed3 1696
a2c4f8e0 1697@defmac WINT_TYPE
1a67c7d3
JL
1698A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1699use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1700@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1701contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1702information.
1703
1704If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1705@end defmac
1a67c7d3 1706
a2c4f8e0 1707@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1708A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1709can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1710The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1711string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1712
1713If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1714@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1715much precision as @code{long long int}.
a2c4f8e0 1716@end defmac
b15ad712 1717
a2c4f8e0 1718@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1719A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1720can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1721type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1722of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1723
1724If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1725@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1726unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1727int}.
a2c4f8e0 1728@end defmac
b15ad712 1729
207bf79d
JM
1730@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1731@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1732@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1733@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1734@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1735@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1736@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1737@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1738@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1739@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1740@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1741@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1742@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1743@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1744@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1745@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1746@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1747@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1748@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1749@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1750@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1751@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1752@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1753@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1754@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1755@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1756@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1757C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1758@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1759@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1760@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1761@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1762@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1763@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1764@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1765@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1766@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1767
1768If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1769type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1770@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1771to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1772these macros are null pointers.
1773@end defmac
1774
a2c4f8e0 1775@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
f3c55c97
AO
1776The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1777that looks like:
1778
3ab51846 1779@smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1780 struct @{
1781 union @{
1782 void (*fn)();
1783 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1784 @};
1785 ptrdiff_t delta;
1786 @};
3ab51846 1787@end smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1788
1789@noindent
1790The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1791will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1792Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1793always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1794distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1795platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1796that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1797the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1798
1799GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1800this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1801However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1802set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1803bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1804address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1805architecture, you should define this macro to
1806@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1807
1808In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1809in which function addresses are always even, according to
1810@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1811@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
a2c4f8e0 1812@end defmac
67231816 1813
a2c4f8e0 1814@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
67231816 1815Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
f282ffb3 1816macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
67231816
RH
1817instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1818function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
f282ffb3 1819data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
67231816
RH
1820pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1821
1822If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1823of words that the function descriptor occupies.
a2c4f8e0 1824@end defmac
a6f5e048 1825
a2c4f8e0 1826@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
a6f5e048
RH
1827By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1828is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1829the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1830when special alignment is necessary. */
a2c4f8e0 1831@end defmac
a6f5e048 1832
a2c4f8e0 1833@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
a6f5e048
RH
1834There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1835zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1836specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1837of words in each data entry.
a2c4f8e0 1838@end defmac
b2b263e1 1839
feca2ed3
JW
1840@node Registers
1841@section Register Usage
1842@cindex register usage
1843
1844This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1845has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1846
1847The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1848done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1849on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1850For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1851For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1852
1853@menu
6ccde948
RW
1854* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1855* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1856* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1857* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1858* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
feca2ed3
JW
1859@end menu
1860
1861@node Register Basics
1862@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1863
1864@c prevent bad page break with this line
1865Registers have various characteristics.
1866
a2c4f8e0 1867@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
feca2ed3
JW
1868Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1869numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1870pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1871@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 1872@end defmac
feca2ed3 1873
a2c4f8e0 1874@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1875@cindex fixed register
1876An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1877all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1878general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1879pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1880register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1881machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1882and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1883
1884This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1885commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1886register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1887
1888The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1889the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1890by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
630d3d5a
JM
1891the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1892@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
a2c4f8e0 1893@end defmac
feca2ed3 1894
a2c4f8e0 1895@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1896@cindex call-used register
1897@cindex call-clobbered register
1898@cindex call-saved register
1899Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1900clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1901registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1902available for general allocation of values that must live across
1903function calls.
1904
1905If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1906automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1907exit, if the register is used within the function.
a2c4f8e0 1908@end defmac
feca2ed3 1909
a2c4f8e0 1910@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
fc1296b7
AM
1911@cindex call-used register
1912@cindex call-clobbered register
1913@cindex call-saved register
f282ffb3
JM
1914Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1915that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
fc1296b7 1916(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
f282ffb3 1917This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
fc1296b7 1918of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1919@end defmac
fc1296b7 1920
a2c4f8e0 1921@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1e326708
MH
1922@cindex call-used register
1923@cindex call-clobbered register
1924@cindex call-saved register
df2a54e9 1925A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1e326708
MH
1926value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1927call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1928macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1929preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
a2c4f8e0 1930@end defmac
1e326708 1931
feca2ed3
JW
1932@findex fixed_regs
1933@findex call_used_regs
a2c4f8e0
ZW
1934@findex global_regs
1935@findex reg_names
1936@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1937@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1938This hook may conditionally modify five variables
055177dc 1939@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
c237e94a
ZW
1940@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1941any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1942of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1943@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1944@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1945called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1946@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
055177dc 1947from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
c237e94a 1948@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
630d3d5a 1949@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
c237e94a
ZW
1950@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1951command options have been applied.
feca2ed3 1952
feca2ed3
JW
1953@cindex disabling certain registers
1954@cindex controlling register usage
1955If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1956flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1957@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
161d7b59 1958registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
97488870
R
1959the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1960to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
feca2ed3
JW
1961is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1962
1963(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1964of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1965controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1966these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1967@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 1968
a2c4f8e0 1969@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
feca2ed3
JW
1970Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1971expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1972corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1973function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1974outbound register.
a2c4f8e0 1975@end defmac
feca2ed3 1976
a2c4f8e0 1977@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
feca2ed3
JW
1978Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1979expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1980corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1981function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1982register.
a2c4f8e0 1983@end defmac
feca2ed3 1984
a2c4f8e0 1985@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
fa80e43d
JL
1986Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1987expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1988register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1989need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1990gotos.
a2c4f8e0 1991@end defmac
fa80e43d 1992
a2c4f8e0 1993@defmac PC_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
1994If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1995register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
a2c4f8e0 1996@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
1997
1998@node Allocation Order
1999@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2000@cindex order of register allocation
2001@cindex register allocation order
2002
2003@c prevent bad page break with this line
2004Registers are allocated in order.
2005
a2c4f8e0 2006@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3 2007If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
a3a15b4d 2008numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
feca2ed3
JW
2009to use them (from most preferred to least).
2010
2011If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2012(all else being equal).
2013
2014One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2015registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2016instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2017machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
956d6950 2018the highest numbered allocable register first.
a2c4f8e0 2019@end defmac
feca2ed3 2020
5a733826 2021@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3
JW
2022A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2023hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2024
2025Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2026Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2027register; and so on.
2028
2029The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2030@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2031
2032On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 2033@end defmac
feca2ed3 2034
5a733826
BS
2035@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2036Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2037prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2038using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2039allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2040call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2041should be defined.
2042@end defmac
2043
058e97ec
VM
2044@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2045In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2046Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2047If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2048based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2049be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2050value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2051to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2052
2053On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2054@end defmac
2055
feca2ed3
JW
2056@node Values in Registers
2057@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2058
2059This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2060(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2061consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2062
a2c4f8e0 2063@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2064A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2065at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
79e168da
DD
2066@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2067cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2068and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
feca2ed3
JW
2069
2070On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2071definition of this macro is
2072
2073@smallexample
2074#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2075 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
32bd3974 2076 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
feca2ed3 2077@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2078@end defmac
feca2ed3 2079
8521c414
JM
2080@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2081A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2082in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2083in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2084multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2085this mode by the number of registers returned by
2086@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2087
2088For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2089registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2090nonzero.
2091
2092This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
f1f4e530 2093@code{subreg_get_info}
8521c414
JM
2094would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2095represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2096@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2097registers and so not be representable.
2098@end defmac
2099
2100@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2101For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2102@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2103returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2104including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2105@end defmac
2106
ca0b6e3b
EB
2107@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2108Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2109of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2110should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2111used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2112happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2113floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2114@end defmac
2115
a2c4f8e0 2116@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2117A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2118of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2119registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2120are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2121
2122@smallexample
2123#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2124@end smallexample
2125
e9a25f70
JL
2126You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2127because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
feca2ed3
JW
2128
2129@cindex register pairs
2130On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
e9a25f70
JL
2131register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2132odd register numbers for such modes.
feca2ed3
JW
2133
2134The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2135@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
e9a25f70
JL
2136register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2137value into the register and back out not alter it.
feca2ed3 2138
e9a25f70
JL
2139Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2140all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
feca2ed3
JW
2141@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2142you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2143is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2144and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2145to be tieable.
2146
2147Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2148Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2149in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2150can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2151mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2152registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2153
2154On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2155modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2156registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2157non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2158@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2159floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2160normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2161unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2162register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2163
2164The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2165they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2166instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2167@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2168constraints for those instructions.
2169
2170On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2171so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2172register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2173floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2174be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
a2c4f8e0 2175@end defmac
feca2ed3 2176
150c9fe8
KH
2177@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2178A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2179@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2180
2181One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2182another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2183handler.
2184
2185The default is always nonzero.
2186@end defmac
2187
a2c4f8e0 2188@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
e9a25f70 2189A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
956d6950 2190@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
feca2ed3
JW
2191
2192If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
e9a25f70
JL
2193@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2194any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2195should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2196this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
956d6950 2197accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
e9a25f70
JL
2198
2199You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
a3a15b4d 2200possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
e9a25f70 2201allocation.
a2c4f8e0 2202@end defmac
7506f491 2203
dbc42c44
AS
2204@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2205This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2206@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2207
2208One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2209is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2210
2211The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2212@end deftypefn
2213
a2c4f8e0 2214@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
7506f491 2215Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a89608cb 2216registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
7506f491 2217@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
a2c4f8e0 2218@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
2219
2220@node Leaf Functions
2221@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2222
2223@cindex leaf functions
2224@cindex functions, leaf
2225On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2226more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2227means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2228are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2229normally arrive.
2230
2231The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2232other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2233registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2234function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2235handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2236functions''.
2237
a3a15b4d 2238GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
feca2ed3
JW
2239suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2240registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2241accomplish this.
2242
a2c4f8e0 2243@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7d167afd 2244Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
feca2ed3
JW
2245contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2246function treatment.
2247
2248If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2249registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
a3a15b4d 2250GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
feca2ed3
JW
2251used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2252in this vector.
2253
2254Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2255the treatment of leaf functions.
a2c4f8e0 2256@end defmac
feca2ed3 2257
a2c4f8e0 2258@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2259A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2260should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2261
2262If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
630d3d5a 2263function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
feca2ed3
JW
2264will cause the compiler to abort.
2265
2266Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2267treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2268this.
a2c4f8e0 2269@end defmac
feca2ed3 2270
54ff41b7
JW
2271@findex current_function_is_leaf
2272@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
c237e94a
ZW
2273@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2274@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2275specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2276which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2277set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
08c148a8
NB
2278compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2279@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2280functions which only use leaf registers.
9ac617d4
EB
2281@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2282that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2283@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
feca2ed3
JW
2284@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2285@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2286
2287@node Stack Registers
2288@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2289
2290There are special features to handle computers where some of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2291``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2292pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2293stack.
feca2ed3 2294
a3a15b4d 2295Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2296they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2297support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2298point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2299stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2300@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2301with it, as well as defining these macros.
2302
2303@defmac STACK_REGS
feca2ed3 2304Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
a2c4f8e0 2305@end defmac
feca2ed3 2306
1833192f
VM
2307@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2308This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2309the machine has any stack-like registers.
2310@end defmac
2311
a2c4f8e0 2312@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2313The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2314of the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2315@end defmac
feca2ed3 2316
a2c4f8e0 2317@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2318The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2319the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2320@end defmac
feca2ed3 2321
feca2ed3
JW
2322@node Register Classes
2323@section Register Classes
2324@cindex register class definitions
2325@cindex class definitions, register
2326
2327On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2328For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2329certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2330restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2331
2332You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2333which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2334that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2335
2336@findex ALL_REGS
2337@findex NO_REGS
2338In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2339class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2340class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2341union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2342
2343@findex GENERAL_REGS
2344One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2345terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2346@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2347the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2348to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2349
2350Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2351then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2352
2353The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2354constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2355You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2356them in operand constraints.
2357
6049a4c8
HPN
2358You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2359registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2360some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2361cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2362(@pxref{Costs}).
2363
feca2ed3
JW
2364You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2365instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2366either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2367certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2368which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2369or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2370class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
feca2ed3
JW
2371
2372You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2373classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2374contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2375in their union.
2376
2377When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2378certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2379Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2380a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2381specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2382
2383Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2384instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2385each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2386mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2387single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2388this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2389instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2390single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2391@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2392
a2c4f8e0 2393@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2eac577f
JM
2394An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2395as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2396must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
feca2ed3
JW
2397@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2398tells how many classes there are.
2399
2400Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2401the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2402in many of the tables described below.
a2c4f8e0 2403@end deftp
feca2ed3 2404
a2c4f8e0 2405@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
feca2ed3
JW
2406The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2407
3ab51846 2408@smallexample
feca2ed3 2409#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
3ab51846 2410@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2411@end defmac
feca2ed3 2412
a2c4f8e0 2413@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
2414An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2415constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
a2c4f8e0 2416@end defmac
feca2ed3 2417
a2c4f8e0 2418@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
feca2ed3
JW
2419An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2420which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2421@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2422register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2423
2424When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2425Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2426several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2427for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
7c272079
MP
2428In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2429registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2430so on.
a2c4f8e0 2431@end defmac
feca2ed3 2432
a2c4f8e0 2433@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2434A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2435@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2436which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2437register.
a2c4f8e0 2438@end defmac
feca2ed3 2439
a2c4f8e0 2440@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2441A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2442base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2443which is the register value plus a displacement.
a2c4f8e0 2444@end defmac
feca2ed3 2445
a2c4f8e0 2446@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
3dcc68a4 2447This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
c0478a66 2448the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
3dcc68a4
NC
2449@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2450@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2451@end defmac
3dcc68a4 2452
888d2cd6
DJ
2453@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2454A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2455base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2456register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2457addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2458@end defmac
2459
86fc3d06 2460@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
c4963a0a 2461A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2462base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2463space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2464define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2465the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2466of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
c4963a0a
BS
2467@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2468index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2469@end defmac
2470
a2c4f8e0 2471@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2472A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2473index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2474address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2475added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
a2c4f8e0 2476@end defmac
feca2ed3 2477
a2c4f8e0 2478@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3 2479A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
1c62e8f2 2480suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
a2c4f8e0 2481@end defmac
feca2ed3 2482
a2c4f8e0 2483@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
861bb6c1
JL
2484A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2485that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2486@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2487reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2488you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
ab873839
RW
2489@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2490addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2491@code{address_operand}.
a2c4f8e0 2492@end defmac
861bb6c1 2493
888d2cd6
DJ
2494@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2495A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2496use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2497memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2498pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2499define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2500than other base register uses.
c4963a0a
BS
2501
2502Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2503@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2504@end defmac
2505
86fc3d06
UW
2506@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2507A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2508suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2509memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2510This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
ab873839
RW
2511that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2512appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2513immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2514address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2515@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2516corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
c4963a0a 2517@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
ab873839 2518that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
888d2cd6
DJ
2519@end defmac
2520
a2c4f8e0 2521@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
2522A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2523suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2524either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2525allocated such a hard register.
2526
2527The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2528the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2529two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2530labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2531labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2532may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2533looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2534only if neither labeling works.
a2c4f8e0 2535@end defmac
feca2ed3 2536
5f286f4a 2537@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
6d3fbe2f 2538A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
5f286f4a
YQ
2539@end deftypefn
2540
fba42e24
AS
2541@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2542A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2545another, smaller class.
2546
2547The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2548
2549Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2550example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2551for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2552@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2553Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2554
2555One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2556@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2557loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2558force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2559immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2560instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2561register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2562@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2563into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2564@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2565of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2566
2567If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2568through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2569to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2570reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2571this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2572the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2573@end deftypefn
2574
a2c4f8e0 2575@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2576A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2577to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2578@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2579another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2580safe:
2581
3ab51846 2582@smallexample
feca2ed3 2583#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
3ab51846 2584@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
2585
2586Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2587example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2588for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2589@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2590Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2591
222a2f1a
GK
2592One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2593@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2594loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2595force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2596immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2597instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2598register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2599@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2600into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2601@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2602of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
b5c82fa1
PB
2603
2604If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2605through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2606to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2607reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2608this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2609the SSE registers (and vice versa).
a2c4f8e0 2610@end defmac
feca2ed3 2611
abd26bfb
AS
2612@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2613Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2614input reloads.
2615
2616The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2617argument.
2618
2619You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2620reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2621@end deftypefn
2622
a2c4f8e0 2623@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2624A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2625to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2626@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2627ordinarily be used.
2628
2629Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2630there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2631
2632The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2633smaller class.
2634
2635Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2636require the macro to do something nontrivial.
a2c4f8e0 2637@end defmac
feca2ed3 2638
a87cf97e 2639@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
feca2ed3
JW
2640Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2641from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2642@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
8a99f6f9
R
2643from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2644term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2645directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2646register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2647destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2648source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2649reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2650and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2651intermediate register still holds the required value.
2652
2653Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2654allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2655register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2656address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2657when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
e4ae5e77 2658as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
8a99f6f9
R
2659that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2660describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2661these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2662of the scratch register(s).
2663
2664In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2665
2666For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
9bdf23b2 2667and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
8a99f6f9 2668@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
9bdf23b2 2669hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
8a99f6f9
R
2670needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2671
2672If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2673an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2674return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2675If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2676If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2677that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2678
2679If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2680perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2681closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2682required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2683copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2684
2685You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2686in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2687and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2688for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2689single-register-class
2690@c [later: or memory]
2691output constraint.
2692
2693When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2694hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2695register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2696have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2697
2698@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2699@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2700@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2701@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2702@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2703@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2704@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2705@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2706
2707
2708@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2709pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2710Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2711in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2712
2713Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2714currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2715to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2716
2717@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2718copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2719(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2720Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2721of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2722forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2723@end deftypefn
2724
2725@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2727@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
083cad55 2728These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
8a99f6f9
R
2729@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2730
2731These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2732target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2733reload phase that it may
feca2ed3
JW
2734need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2735register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2736register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
8a99f6f9 2737you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
feca2ed3
JW
2738largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2739intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2740
2741If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2742intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
8a99f6f9
R
2743was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2744class required. If the
2745requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2746@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
feca2ed3
JW
2747macros identically.
2748
2749The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2750Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2751can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2752@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2753macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2754
2755If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
8a99f6f9 2756intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
feca2ed3 2757@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
8a99f6f9 2758(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
feca2ed3
JW
2759implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2760@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2761register.
2762
8a99f6f9
R
2763These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2764register that
feca2ed3
JW
2765contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2766class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2767value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2768register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2769Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2770
2771@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2772pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
630d3d5a 2773Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
feca2ed3
JW
2774in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2775
2776These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2777registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2778registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2779would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
a8154559 2780the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
feca2ed3
JW
2781intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2782general registers.
a2c4f8e0 2783@end defmac
feca2ed3 2784
a2c4f8e0 2785@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
feca2ed3
JW
2786Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2787to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
df2a54e9 2788those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
feca2ed3
JW
2789@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2790class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2791and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2792
2793Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
a2c4f8e0 2794@end defmac
feca2ed3 2795
a2c4f8e0 2796@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2797Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2798allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2799If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2800defined by this macro.
2801
2802Do not define this macro if you do not define
2803@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
a2c4f8e0 2804@end defmac
feca2ed3 2805
a2c4f8e0 2806@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2807When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2808registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2809hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2810load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2811same as that of @var{mode}.
2812
2813This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2814bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2815in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2816registers.
2817
2818However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2819the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2820differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2821widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2822suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2823details.
2824
2825Do not define this macro if you do not define
2826@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2827is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
a2c4f8e0 2828@end defmac
feca2ed3 2829
07b8f0a8
AS
2830@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2831A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2832to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2833registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2834
2835The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2836has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2837default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2838if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2839hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2840@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2841@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2842register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2843you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2844the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2845allocation.
2846@end deftypefn
2847
a8c44c52
AS
2848@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2849A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2850of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2851
2852This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2853the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2854@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2855@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2856values in the class @var{rclass}.
2857
2858This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2859in the reload pass.
2860
2861The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2862in words.
2863@end deftypefn
2864
a2c4f8e0 2865@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2866A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2867of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2868
2869This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2870the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2871should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2872@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2873
2874This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2875in the reload pass.
a2c4f8e0 2876@end defmac
feca2ed3 2877
a2c4f8e0 2878@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
b0c42aed
JH
2879If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2880a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
feca2ed3
JW
2881
2882For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
57694e40 2883floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
feca2ed3 2884Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
57694e40 2885does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
cff9f8d5
AH
2886register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2887as below:
02188693 2888
3ab51846 2889@smallexample
b0c42aed
JH
2890#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2891 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2892 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
3ab51846 2893@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2894@end defmac
feca2ed3 2895
55a2c322
VM
2896@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2897A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2898@end deftypefn
2899
2900@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2901A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2902@end deftypefn
2903
2904@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2905A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2906@end deftypefn
2907
2908@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2909This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2910@end deftypefn
2911
f38840db
ZW
2912@node Old Constraints
2913@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2914@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2915@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2916
2917Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2918of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2919Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2920it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2921
2922@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2923For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2924@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2925constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2926you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2927constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2928DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2929to handle specially.
2930There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2931for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2932transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2933return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2934will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2935@end defmac
2936
2937@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2938A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2939letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2940value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2941the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2942corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2943to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2944@end defmac
2945
2946@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2947Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2948passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2949different variants.
2950@end defmac
feca2ed3 2951
a2c4f8e0 2952@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
e119b68c
MM
2953A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2954letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2955particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2956letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2957the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2958not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2959@var{value}.
a2c4f8e0 2960@end defmac
feca2ed3 2961
a2c4f8e0 2962@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
2963Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2964string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2965between different variants.
a2c4f8e0 2966@end defmac
97488870 2967
a2c4f8e0 2968@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
feca2ed3 2969A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
e119b68c
MM
2970letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2971(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
feca2ed3
JW
2972
2973If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2974@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2975range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2976letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2977
2978@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2979@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2980or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2981between these kinds.
a2c4f8e0 2982@end defmac
feca2ed3 2983
a2c4f8e0 2984@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
2985Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2986string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2987between different variants.
a2c4f8e0 2988@end defmac
97488870 2989
a2c4f8e0 2990@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
feca2ed3 2991A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
c2cba7a9
RH
2992letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2993memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
97488870
R
2994elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2995@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
c2cba7a9
RH
2996may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2997
2998If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2999if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3000constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
e119b68c 3001constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
feca2ed3 3002
c2cba7a9
RH
3003For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3004in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3005letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
feca2ed3
JW
3006@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3007a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3008alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3009does not include r0 on the output.
a2c4f8e0 3010@end defmac
ccfc6cc8 3011
a2c4f8e0 3012@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
97488870
R
3013Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3014in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3015variants.
a2c4f8e0 3016@end defmac
97488870 3017
a2c4f8e0 3018@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
ccfc6cc8
UW
3019A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3020letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3021be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3022
73774972 3023It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
97488870 3024at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
6ccde948 3025comprises a subset of all memory references including
73774972
EC
3026all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3027pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
ccfc6cc8
UW
3028type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3029
3030For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3031memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3032register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3033@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3034If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3035a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3036reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3037into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
e4ae5e77 3038an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 3039@end defmac
ccfc6cc8 3040
a2c4f8e0 3041@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
ccfc6cc8 3042A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
97488870
R
3043letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3044@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
ccfc6cc8
UW
3045be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3046
73774972 3047It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3a6e2189 3048at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
97488870 3049a subset of all memory addresses including
73774972
EC
3050all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3051pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
97488870 3052type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
ccfc6cc8
UW
3053
3054Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
73774972 3055be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
ccfc6cc8 3056analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
a2c4f8e0 3057@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3058
3059@node Stack and Calling
3060@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3061@cindex calling conventions
3062
3063@c prevent bad page break with this line
3064This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3065
3066@menu
3067* Frame Layout::
7c16328b 3068* Exception Handling::
861bb6c1 3069* Stack Checking::
feca2ed3
JW
3070* Frame Registers::
3071* Elimination::
3072* Stack Arguments::
3073* Register Arguments::
3074* Scalar Return::
3075* Aggregate Return::
3076* Caller Saves::
3077* Function Entry::
3078* Profiling::
91d231cb 3079* Tail Calls::
7d69de61 3080* Stack Smashing Protection::
feca2ed3
JW
3081@end menu
3082
3083@node Frame Layout
3084@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3085@cindex stack frame layout
3086@cindex frame layout
3087
3088@c prevent bad page break with this line
3089Here is the basic stack layout.
3090
a2c4f8e0 3091@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
3092Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3093pointer to a smaller address.
3094
d78aa55c 3095When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
feca2ed3
JW
3096compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3097definition used does not matter.
a2c4f8e0 3098@end defmac
feca2ed3 3099
a2c4f8e0 3100@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
918a6124
GK
3101This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3102on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
04a5176a 3103@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
918a6124
GK
3104
3105The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3106and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3107the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3108to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3109space for the next item on the stack.
3110
3111The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3112defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3113which is often wrong.
a2c4f8e0 3114@end defmac
918a6124 3115
a2c4f8e0 3116@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
a4d05547 3117Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
f62c8a5c 3118are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
a2c4f8e0 3119@end defmac
feca2ed3 3120
a2c4f8e0 3121@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
3122Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3123addresses on the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3124@end defmac
feca2ed3 3125
a2c4f8e0 3126@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
3127Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3128
3129If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3130subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3131Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3132value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3133@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3134@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
a2c4f8e0 3135@end defmac
feca2ed3 3136
a2c4f8e0 3137@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
95f3f59e 3138Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
0b4be7de 3139The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
95f3f59e 3140
0b4be7de 3141On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
95f3f59e
JDA
3142is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3143alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3144stack alignment and do it in the backend.
a2c4f8e0 3145@end defmac
95f3f59e 3146
a2c4f8e0 3147@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
3148Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3149outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3150zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3151
3152If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3153the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
a2c4f8e0 3154@end defmac
feca2ed3 3155
a2c4f8e0 3156@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3157Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3158address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3159function.
3160
3161If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3162the first argument's address.
a2c4f8e0 3163@end defmac
feca2ed3 3164
a2c4f8e0 3165@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3166Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3167on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3168
3169The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3170length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3171machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
a2c4f8e0 3172@end defmac
feca2ed3 3173
c6d01079
AK
3174@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3175A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
083cad55 3176stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
c8f27794
JW
3177@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3178default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
083cad55 3179elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
c8f27794 3180@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
c6d01079
AK
3181@end defmac
3182
a2c4f8e0 3183@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3
JW
3184A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3185frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3186@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3187itself.
3188
3189If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3190of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3191address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
a2c4f8e0 3192@end defmac
feca2ed3 3193
a2c4f8e0 3194@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
feca2ed3
JW
3195If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3196setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
981f6289 3197on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
0bc02db4
MS
3198before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3199define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3200@end defmac
0bc02db4 3201
9ddb66ef 3202@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
d6da68b9 3203This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
0bc02db4
MS
3204the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3205The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
d6da68b9 3206machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
0bc02db4 3207@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
d6da68b9 3208@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3209
224869d9
EB
3210@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3211A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3212address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3213of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3214You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3215as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3216@end defmac
3217
a2c4f8e0 3218@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3 3219A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
861bb6c1
JL
3220address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3221the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3222frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
feca2ed3
JW
3223@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3224
e9a25f70 3225The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
4830ba1f 3226@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
e9a25f70 3227determine the return address of other frames.
a2c4f8e0 3228@end defmac
e9a25f70 3229
a2c4f8e0 3230@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
feca2ed3
JW
3231Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3232from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
a2c4f8e0 3233@end defmac
861bb6c1 3234
a2c4f8e0 3235@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
861bb6c1
JL
3236A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3237incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3238prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3239value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3240the stack.
3241
3242You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3243debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3244
2c849145 3245If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
aee96fe9 3246@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
a2c4f8e0 3247@end defmac
2c849145 3248
ed80cd68 3249@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
73774972 3250A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
5cd0f915
RS
3251number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3252must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3253be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3254
3255This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3256general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3257frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3258over time.
ed80cd68
RH
3259@end defmac
3260
282efe1c
RH
3261@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3262A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3263number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3264only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3265someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3266terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3267@end defmac
3268
e54c7471
EB
3269@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3270This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3271contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3272info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3273@smallexample
923158be 3274(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
e54c7471
EB
3275@end smallexample
3276and
3277@smallexample
923158be 3278(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
e54c7471
EB
3279@end smallexample
3280to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3281the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3282the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3283@end deftypefn
3284
a2c4f8e0 3285@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
861bb6c1
JL
3286A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3287from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3288frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3289the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3290previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3291
71038426
RH
3292You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3293debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3294@end defmac
71038426 3295
a2c4f8e0 3296@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
71038426
RH
3297A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3298from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
02f52e19 3299final value should coincide with that calculated by
71038426
RH
3300@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3301during virtual register instantiation.
3302
d17c29c3
PB
3303The default value for this macro is
3304@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2c849145 3305which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
208e52d9
JM
3306immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3307some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3308and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2c849145 3309
208e52d9 3310You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2c849145
JM
3311want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3312DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3313@end defmac
512b62fb 3314
f6672e8e
RH
3315@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3316If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3317in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
6fc0bb99 3318The final value should coincide with that calculated by
f6672e8e
RH
3319@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3320
3321Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
083cad55 3322via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
f6672e8e 3323variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
6416ae7f 3324defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
f6672e8e
RH
3325based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3326of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3327should be defined.
3328@end defmac
3329
35d177a2
AO
3330@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3331If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3332in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3333in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3334may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3335@end defmac
3336
7c16328b
RH
3337@node Exception Handling
3338@subsection Exception Handling Support
3339@cindex exception handling
3340
a2c4f8e0 3341@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
52a11cbf
RH
3342A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3343data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3344@var{N} registers are usable.
3345
3346The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3347handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3348should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3349but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33502 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3351
3352You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3353handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3354@end defmac
52a11cbf 3355
a2c4f8e0 3356@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
52a11cbf
RH
3357A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3358to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3359This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3360It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3361
02f52e19 3362Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
52a11cbf
RH
3363untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3364
34dc173c 3365Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
73774972
EC
3366by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3367this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3368stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3369this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
34dc173c 3370that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3371@end defmac
52a11cbf 3372
a2c4f8e0 3373@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
52a11cbf 3374A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
02f52e19 3375to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
52a11cbf
RH
3376return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3377
3378Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
02f52e19
AJ
3379return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3380address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
52a11cbf 3381the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
73774972
EC
3382frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3383been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
34dc173c 3384target call frame.
52a11cbf
RH
3385
3386Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3387address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3388the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3389
3390If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3391define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
a2c4f8e0 3392@end defmac
52a11cbf 3393
1e60c057
R
3394@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3395If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3396to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3397exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3398using it to return to the exception handler.
3399@end defmac
3400
a2c4f8e0 3401@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
2a1ee410
RH
3402This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3403handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3404that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3405and so may be read-only.
3406
aee96fe9
JM
3407@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3408@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2a1ee410
RH
3409The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3410as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3411
ebb48a4d 3412If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2a1ee410 3413represented directly.
a2c4f8e0 3414@end defmac
2a1ee410 3415
a2c4f8e0 3416@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2a1ee410
RH
3417This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3418to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3419Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3420be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3421
aee96fe9
JM
3422This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3423handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3424of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2a1ee410 3425to be emitted.
a2c4f8e0 3426@end defmac
2a1ee410 3427
8662eb14 3428@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
44082375 3429This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
7c16328b
RH
3430code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3431available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3432through signal frames.
3433
614e5a7d
BE
3434This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3435@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3436@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
7c16328b
RH
3437@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3438for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
614e5a7d
BE
3439the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3440save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3441evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3442the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
8207b189
FS
3443
3444For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3445@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
a2c4f8e0 3446@end defmac
861bb6c1 3447
3950dcdf
JJ
3448@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3449This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3450call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3451usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3452
0c93ed52
SB
3453This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3454@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3950dcdf
JJ
3455@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3456for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3457@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3458be updated in @var{fs}.
3459@end defmac
3460
4746cf84
MA
3461@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3462A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3463info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3464linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3465@end defmac
3466
861bb6c1
JL
3467@node Stack Checking
3468@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3469
b38f3813
EB
3470GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3471stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3472three ways:
861bb6c1
JL
3473
3474@enumerate
3475@item
a3a15b4d 3476If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
b38f3813
EB
3477will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3478at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3479other special processing.
861bb6c1
JL
3480
3481@item
b38f3813
EB
3482If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3483@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3484that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3485static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3486in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3487stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3488approach below.
861bb6c1
JL
3489
3490@item
a3a15b4d 3491If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
861bb6c1
JL
3492``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3493@end enumerate
3494
b38f3813
EB
3495If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3496GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3497@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3498dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
861bb6c1 3499
a2c4f8e0 3500@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
861bb6c1 3501A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
02f52e19 3502machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
65a324b4 3503is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
b38f3813
EB
3504checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3505value of this macro is zero.
3506@end defmac
3507
3508@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3509A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3510in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3511like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3512approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
a2c4f8e0 3513@end defmac
861bb6c1 3514
d809253a
EB
3515@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3516An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3517instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3518define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3519the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3520of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 3521@end defmac
861bb6c1 3522
d809253a
EB
3523@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3524An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3525when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3526contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3527thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3528is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3529default value of this macro is zero.
3530@end defmac
3531
a2c4f8e0 3532@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
507d0069
EB
3533The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3534languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3535with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35368192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3537most machines.
a2c4f8e0 3538@end defmac
861bb6c1 3539
b38f3813
EB
3540The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3541nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3542in the opposite case.
3543
a2c4f8e0 3544@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3545The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
861bb6c1
JL
3546instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3547stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
a3a15b4d
JL
3548checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3549default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
861bb6c1 3550systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3551@end defmac
861bb6c1 3552
a2c4f8e0 3553@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3554GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
861bb6c1
JL
3555represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3556space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3557You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3558use the default of four words.
a2c4f8e0 3559@end defmac
861bb6c1 3560
a2c4f8e0 3561@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3562The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
861bb6c1 3563fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
630d3d5a 3564@option{-fstack-check}.
a3a15b4d 3565GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
861bb6c1 3566normally not need to override that default.
a2c4f8e0 3567@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3568
3569@need 2000
3570@node Frame Registers
3571@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3572
3573@c prevent bad page break with this line
3574This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3575
a2c4f8e0 3576@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3577The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3578fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3579the hardware determines which register this is.
a2c4f8e0 3580@end defmac
feca2ed3 3581
a2c4f8e0 3582@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3583The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3584access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3585hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3586choose any register you wish for this purpose.
a2c4f8e0 3587@end defmac
feca2ed3 3588
a2c4f8e0 3589@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3590On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3591offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3592allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3593between these two locations). On those machines, define
3594@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3595be used internally until the offset is known, and define
556e0f21 3596@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
feca2ed3
JW
3597used for the frame pointer.
3598
3599You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3600is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3601the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3602completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3603definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3604@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3605or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3606
3607Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3608@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
a2c4f8e0 3609@end defmac
feca2ed3 3610
a2c4f8e0 3611@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3612The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3613the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3614frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3615register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3616wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3617pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3618@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3619(@pxref{Elimination}).
a2c4f8e0 3620@end defmac
feca2ed3 3621
e3339d0f
JM
3622@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3623Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3624@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3625the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3626== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3627definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3628@end defmac
3629
3630@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3631Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3632@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3633same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3634ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3635definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3636@end defmac
3637
a2c4f8e0 3638@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3639The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3640access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3641machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3642pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3643to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3644@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3645
3646Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3647address from the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3648@end defmac
feca2ed3 3649
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3650@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3651@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3652Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3653register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3654function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3655number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3656these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
bd819a4a 3657not be defined.
feca2ed3
JW
3658
3659The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3660
3661If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2b4fa409 3662defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
a2c4f8e0 3663@end defmac
919543ab 3664
531ca746
RH
3665@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3666This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3667targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3668nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3669attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3670those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3671
3672The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
2b4fa409
RH
3673
3674If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3675provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3676Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3677from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3678will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3679@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3680@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3681@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3682The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3683@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3684to refer to those items.
531ca746
RH
3685@end deftypefn
3686
a2c4f8e0 3687@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3688This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3689saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3690DWARF2 exception handling.
3691
3692Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3693exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3694extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3695in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3696used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3697routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3698registers that are not call-saved.
3699
3700If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3701@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 3702@end defmac
919543ab 3703
a2c4f8e0 3704@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3705
3706This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3707for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3708
3709If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3710@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 3711@end defmac
919543ab 3712
a2c4f8e0 3713@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
41f3a930
AH
3714
3715Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3716is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
61aeb06f 3717Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
41f3a930
AH
3718column number to use instead.
3719
73774972 3720See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
a2c4f8e0 3721@end defmac
feca2ed3 3722
34c80057
AM
3723@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3724
3725Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3726used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
2dd76960 3727debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
34c80057
AM
3728should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3729@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3730
3731@end defmac
3732
3733@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3734
3735Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
2dd76960 3736that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
34c80057 3737should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
f676971a 3738.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
34c80057
AM
3739return @code{@var{regno}}.
3740
3741@end defmac
3742
cca2207a
L
3743@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3744
3745Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3746@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3747target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3748default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3749
3750@end defmac
3751
3752@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3753
3754Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3755context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3756it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3757defined and 0 otherwise.
3758
3759@end defmac
3760
feca2ed3
JW
3761@node Elimination
3762@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3763
3764@c prevent bad page break with this line
3765This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3766
b52b1749
AS
3767@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3768This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3769a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3770value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
feca2ed3 3771
b52b1749 3772This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
aea88c05
AS
3773according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3774constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3775to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3776Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3777pointer.
feca2ed3
JW
3778
3779In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3780without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3781automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
b52b1749 3782@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
bd819a4a 3783them.
feca2ed3
JW
3784
3785In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3786register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3787fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
aea88c05 3788
b52b1749
AS
3789Default return value is @code{false}.
3790@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3791
feca2ed3 3792@findex get_frame_size
a2c4f8e0 3793@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3794A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3795between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3796the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3797such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3798registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3799
3800If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3801need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
65a324b4 3802@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
feca2ed3 3803case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
a2c4f8e0 3804@end defmac
feca2ed3 3805
a2c4f8e0 3806@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
feca2ed3
JW
3807If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3808eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3809defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3810references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3811
3812The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3813of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3814
3815On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3816the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3817must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3818replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3819depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3820
3821In this case, you might specify:
3ab51846 3822@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3823#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3824@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3825 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3826 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3ab51846 3827@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3828
3829Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3830specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
a2c4f8e0 3831@end defmac
feca2ed3 3832
9ddb66ef 3833@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
7b5cbb57 3834This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
9ddb66ef
JR
3835try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3836@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3be639f7 3837is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
feca2ed3
JW
3838preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3839knows about.
3be639f7 3840
7b5cbb57
AS
3841Default return value is @code{true}.
3842@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3843
a2c4f8e0 3844@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3845This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3846specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3847registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3848defined.
a2c4f8e0 3849@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3850
3851@node Stack Arguments
3852@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3853@cindex arguments on stack
3854@cindex stack arguments
3855
3856The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3857on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3858control passing certain arguments in registers.
3859
9ddb66ef 3860@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
3861This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3862prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3863passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3864cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3865The default is to not promote prototypes.
3866@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3867
a2c4f8e0 3868@defmac PUSH_ARGS
767094dd 3869A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
f73ad30e
JH
3870outgoing arguments.
3871If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3872That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3873allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
aee96fe9 3874it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
a2c4f8e0 3875@end defmac
f73ad30e 3876
9d6bef95
JM
3877@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3878A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3879last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3880defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3881and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3882@end defmac
3883
a2c4f8e0 3884@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
feca2ed3
JW
3885A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3886stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
feca2ed3
JW
3887
3888On some machines, the definition
3889
3ab51846 3890@smallexample
feca2ed3 3891#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3ab51846 3892@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3893
3894@noindent
3895will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3896to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3897alignment. Then the definition should be
3898
3ab51846 3899@smallexample
feca2ed3 3900#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3ab51846 3901@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3902
64ad7c99 3903If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 3904@end defmac
feca2ed3 3905
29454ff5
SL
3906@findex outgoing_args_size
3907@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
a2c4f8e0 3908@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
767094dd 3909A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
29454ff5
SL
3910will be computed and placed into
3911@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
feca2ed3
JW
3912onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3913increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3914
f73ad30e 3915Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
feca2ed3 3916is not proper.
a2c4f8e0 3917@end defmac
feca2ed3 3918
a2c4f8e0 3919@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3920Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3921allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3922registers.
3923
3924The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
ab87f8c8 3925arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
a3a15b4d 3926which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
5d059ed9
KT
3927The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3928of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3929
3930This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3931machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3932which.
a2c4f8e0 3933@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3934@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3935@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3936
81464b2c
KT
3937@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3938Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3939caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3940when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3941if the function called is a library function.
feca2ed3
JW
3942
3943If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3944whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
29454ff5 3945@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
a2c4f8e0 3946@end defmac
feca2ed3 3947
a2c4f8e0 3948@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
feca2ed3
JW
3949Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3950stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3951@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3952@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3953
3954Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3955stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3956suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3957stack in its natural location.
a2c4f8e0 3958@end defmac
feca2ed3 3959
893d13d5 3960@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
079e7538
NF
3961This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3962a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3963and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
feca2ed3
JW
3964
3965@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3966the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3967@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
91d231cb 3968From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3969
3970@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3971describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3972@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3973From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3974arguments (if known).
3975
861bb6c1 3976When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
feca2ed3
JW
3977will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3978you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3979by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3980a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3981in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3982
893d13d5 3983@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
feca2ed3
JW
3984stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3985argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3986
8aeea6e6 3987On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3988of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
feca2ed3
JW
3989calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3990the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3991convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3992arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3993nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3994@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3995number of arguments.
079e7538 3996@end deftypefn
fa5322fa 3997
a2c4f8e0 3998@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
fa5322fa
AO
3999A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4000pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4001when compiling a function call.
4002
4003@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4004have been accumulated.
4005
4006On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4007that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4008that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4009call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4010appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 4011@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4012
4013@node Register Arguments
4014@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4015@cindex arguments in registers
4016@cindex registers arguments
4017
4018This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4019types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4020the stack.
4021
d5cc9181 4022@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
4023Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4024register and if so, which register.
feca2ed3 4025
b25b9e8f 4026The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
feca2ed3
JW
4027arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4028the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4029(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
4030which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4031nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4032function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4033syntax error has previously occurred.
feca2ed3 4034
b25b9e8f
NF
4035The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4036register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4037on the stack.
feca2ed3 4038
161d7b59 4039The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
feca2ed3 4040used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
ce376beb 4041@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
feca2ed3 4042@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
f797c10b
NC
4043describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4044@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4045register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4046register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4047second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4048the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
02f52e19 4049As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
c980b85b
NC
4050RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4051argument is also stored on the stack.
feca2ed3 4052
b25b9e8f 4053The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
1cc5e432
GK
4054VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4055pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4056
feca2ed3 4057@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
4058The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4059machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4060cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4061done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4062@var{named} is @code{false}.
4063
4064@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4065@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
fe984136 4066You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
feca2ed3
JW
4067in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4068type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 4069is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
feca2ed3
JW
4070argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4071defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4072a register.
b25b9e8f 4073@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4074
9ddb66ef 4075@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
fe984136
RH
4076This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4077solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
d9a4ee00
JL
4078definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4079documentation.
fe984136 4080@end deftypefn
d9a4ee00 4081
d5cc9181 4082@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f 4083Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
feca2ed3
JW
4084that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4085necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4086argument.
4087
b25b9e8f
NF
4088For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4089which the caller passes the value, and
4090@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4091fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4092arrive.
feca2ed3 4093
b25b9e8f
NF
4094If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4095@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4096@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4097
d5cc9181 4098@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
78a52f11
RH
4099This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4100argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
feca2ed3
JW
4101arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4102pushed on the stack.
4103
4104On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4105registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
78a52f11 4106first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
feca2ed3
JW
4107on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4108structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4109in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
78a52f11 4110compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
feca2ed3 4111
b25b9e8f 4112@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
feca2ed3 4113register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4114@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
78a52f11 4115@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4116
d5cc9181 4117@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f676971a 4118This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
8cd5a4e0 4119position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
f676971a 4120predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
8cd5a4e0
RH
4121passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4122
4123If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
feca2ed3
JW
4124pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4125The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4126to that type.
8cd5a4e0 4127@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4128
d5cc9181 4129@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
6cdd5672
RH
4130The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4131known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4132function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4133by the caller.
4134
a1c496cb 4135For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
6cdd5672
RH
4136determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4137not be generated.
4138
4139The default version of this hook always returns false.
4140@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4141
a2c4f8e0 4142@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4143A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4144of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4145target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4146of bytes of argument so far.
feca2ed3
JW
4147
4148There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4149arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4150variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4151arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4152@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4153should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 4154@end defmac
feca2ed3 4155
7c800926
KT
4156@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4157If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4158function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4159created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4160reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4161If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4162@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4163@end defmac
4164
0f6937fe 4165@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
a2c4f8e0
ZW
4166A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4167@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4168variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4169is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4170the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4171For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4172declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4173@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
0f6937fe
AM
4174being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4175arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4176parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
78466c0e 4177@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
feca2ed3
JW
4178
4179When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4180@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4181contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4182an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4183macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4184never both of them at once.
a2c4f8e0 4185@end defmac
feca2ed3 4186
a2c4f8e0 4187@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
97fc4caf
AO
4188Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4189it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4190@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4191is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41920)} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 4193@end defmac
97fc4caf 4194
a2c4f8e0 4195@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
feca2ed3
JW
4196Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4197finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4198undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4199
4200The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
161d7b59 4201with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
feca2ed3
JW
4202argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4203@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4204@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4205@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4206@end defmac
feca2ed3 4207
d5cc9181 4208@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
4209This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4210advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4211@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4212the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4213argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
feca2ed3 4214
b25b9e8f 4215This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
feca2ed3
JW
4216on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4217used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4218@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4219
099590dc
MM
4220@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4221If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4222offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4223which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4224slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4225top.
4226@end defmac
4227
a2c4f8e0 4228@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
4229If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4230to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4231@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4232@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4233
123148b5
BS
4234The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4235target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4236always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
feca2ed3
JW
4237
4238This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4239For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4240big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4241constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 4242@end defmac
feca2ed3 4243
a2c4f8e0 4244@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
02f52e19
AJ
4245If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4246implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
5e4f6244
CP
4247next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4248controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4249arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
a2c4f8e0 4250@end defmac
5e4f6244 4251
6e985040
AM
4252@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4253Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4254memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4255macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4256machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4257@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4258registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4259a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4260required.
4261@end defmac
4262
c2ed6cf8 4263@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
2b0d3573 4264This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4265with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4266@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4267@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4268
123148b5
BS
4269@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4270Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4271which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4272return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4273value.
4274@end deftypefn
4275
a2c4f8e0 4276@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4277A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4278register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4279@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4280the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4281used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4282stack.
a2c4f8e0 4283@end defmac
bb1b857a 4284
9ddb66ef 4285@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
42ba5130
RH
4286This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4287as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4288arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4289to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4290AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4291registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4292point register.
4293
4294The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4295false.
4296@end deftypefn
ded9bf77 4297
d3da4d14
RH
4298@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4299This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4300The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4301@end deftypefn
4302
07a5b2bc 4303@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
d4048208
KT
4304This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4305to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4306variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4307to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
d4048208 4308variable.
07a5b2bc 4309The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
d4048208
KT
4310this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4311internal type.
4312If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4313Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4314macro to iterate through all types.
4315@end deftypefn
4316
35cbb299
KT
4317@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4318This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4319@var{fndecl}.
4320The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4321@end deftypefn
4322
4323@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4324This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4325type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4326@code{NULL_TREE}.
4327@end deftypefn
4328
9ddb66ef 4329@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
23a60a04
JM
4330This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4331@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4332arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4333@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
23a60a04
JM
4334@end deftypefn
4335
e09ec166
EC
4336@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4337Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4338with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4339hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4340@end deftypefn
4341
7352c013
RG
4342@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4343Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4344@end deftypefn
4345
6dd53648
RH
4346@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4347Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4348insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4349considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4350must work.
4351
4352The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4353required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4354Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4355code in @file{optabs.c}.
4356@end deftypefn
4357
f676971a
EC
4358@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4359Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4360insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4361must have move patterns for this mode.
4362@end deftypefn
4363
0f6d54f7
RS
4364@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4365Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4366of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4367Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4368and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4369
4370One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4371that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4372has operations like:
4373
4374@smallexample
4375int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4376@end smallexample
4377
4378where the return type is defined as:
4379
4380@smallexample
4381typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4382@{
4383 int8x8_t val[3];
4384@} int8x8x3_t;
4385@end smallexample
4386
4387If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4388@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4389@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4390@end deftypefn
4391
42db504c
SB
4392@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4393Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4394small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4395@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4396in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4397In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4398for any mode.
4399
4400On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4401insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4402to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4403if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4404insn.
4405
4406Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4407in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4408the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4409classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4410registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4411registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4412SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4413strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4414machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4415
2b0d3573 4416The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
42db504c
SB
4417safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4418unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4419that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4420to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4421of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4422@end deftypefn
4423
e692f276
RH
4424@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4425If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4426@end deftypevr
4427
feca2ed3
JW
4428@node Scalar Return
4429@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4430@cindex return values in registers
4431@cindex values, returned by functions
4432@cindex scalars, returned as values
4433
4434This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4435values---values that can fit in registers.
4436
9ddb66ef 4437@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
1b03c58a
RG
4438
4439Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4440returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
e4ae5e77 4441representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
1b03c58a
RG
4442representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4443function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4444compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4445Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4446a function returns a value.
4447
4448On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4449(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4450place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4451@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4452The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4453multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
576c9028
KH
4454@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4455location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4456the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4457that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4458port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4459@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
1b03c58a
RG
4460
4461If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4462the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4463@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
feca2ed3
JW
4464
4465If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4466node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4467pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4468convention for specific functions when all their calls are
bd819a4a 4469known.
feca2ed3 4470
1b03c58a
RG
4471Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4472which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4473the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4474different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4475
4476@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4477aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
cea28603 4478@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
1b03c58a
RG
4479@end deftypefn
4480
4481@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4482This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4483a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4484@end defmac
feca2ed3 4485
a2c4f8e0 4486@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3 4487A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
dc672951 4488function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3
JW
4489
4490Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4491support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4492specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4493compiled.
a2c4f8e0 4494@end defmac
feca2ed3 4495
38f8b050 4496@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
390b17c2 4497Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4498function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
390b17c2
RE
4499
4500The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4501library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
390b17c2
RE
4502representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4503
4504If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4505@end deftypefn
4506
a2c4f8e0 4507@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4508A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4509register in which the values of called function may come back.
4510
4511A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4512second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4513recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4514suffices:
4515
3ab51846 4516@smallexample
feca2ed3 4517#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3ab51846 4518@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
4519
4520If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4521function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4522should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
82f81f18
AS
4523
4524This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4525for a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4526@end defmac
feca2ed3 4527
82f81f18
AS
4528@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4529A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4530register in which the values of called function may come back.
4531
4532A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4533second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4534recognized by this target hook.
4535
4536If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4537function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4538should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4539
4540If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4541@end deftypefn
4542
a2c4f8e0 4543@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
4544Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4545need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4546saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
a2c4f8e0 4547@end defmac
feca2ed3 4548
9ddb66ef 4549@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
c988af2b
RS
4550This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4551at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4552padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4553is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4554
1b03c58a
RG
4555Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4556be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4557or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45584-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4559@code{SImode} rtx.
c988af2b
RS
4560@end deftypefn
4561
feca2ed3
JW
4562@node Aggregate Return
4563@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4564@cindex aggregates as return values
4565@cindex large return values
4566@cindex returning aggregate values
4567@cindex structure value address
4568
4569When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
1b03c58a
RG
4570cases), the value is not returned according to
4571@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4572caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4573should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4574address}.
feca2ed3
JW
4575
4576This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4577memory.
4578
9ddb66ef 4579@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
4580This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4581function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4582Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4583will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4584libcalls.
feca2ed3
JW
4585
4586Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
61f71b34 4587by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
feca2ed3 4588takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
61f71b34 4589possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
feca2ed3
JW
4590definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4591values, and 0 otherwise.
4592
61f71b34 4593Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
feca2ed3
JW
4594be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4595to indicate this.
61f71b34 4596@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4597
a2c4f8e0 4598@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4599Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4600in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
161d7b59 4601only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
feca2ed3 4602If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
d624465f
KH
4603and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4604target hook.
feca2ed3
JW
4605
4606If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
a2c4f8e0 4607@end defmac
feca2ed3 4608
61f71b34
DD
4609@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4610This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4611address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4612passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
1f6acb82
KH
4613be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4614hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4615argument.
feca2ed3 4616
feca2ed3
JW
4617On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4618is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4619caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4620be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
2225b57c
CD
4621@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4622the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
61f71b34 4623the caller.
feca2ed3 4624
917f1b7e 4625If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
2225b57c
CD
4626stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4627@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
64ee9490 4628structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
2225b57c 4629to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
61f71b34 4630@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4631
a2c4f8e0 4632@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4633Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4634for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4635the address of a static variable containing the value.
4636
4637Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4638pass an address to the subroutine.
4639
630d3d5a
JM
4640This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4641nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
a2c4f8e0 4642@end defmac
feca2ed3 4643
ffa88471
SE
4644@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4645This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4646@end deftypefn
4647
4648@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4649This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4650@end deftypefn
4651
feca2ed3
JW
4652@node Caller Saves
4653@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4654
a3a15b4d 4655If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
feca2ed3
JW
4656makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4657must live across calls.
4658
a2c4f8e0 4659@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
feca2ed3
JW
4660A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4661a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4662restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4663this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4664
4665If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4666machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
a2c4f8e0 4667@end defmac
8d5c8167 4668
a2c4f8e0 4669@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
8d5c8167
JL
4670A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4671of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4672@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4673returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4674will select the smallest suitable mode.
a2c4f8e0 4675@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4676
4677@node Function Entry
4678@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4679@cindex function entry and exit
4680@cindex prologue
4681@cindex epilogue
4682
4683This section describes the macros that output function entry
4684(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4685
08c148a8
NB
4686@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4687If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
feca2ed3
JW
4688function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4689initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4690saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4691local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4692stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4693
4694The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4695macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4696
4697@findex regs_ever_live
4698To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4699@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4700@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4701prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
08c148a8 4702call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
feca2ed3
JW
4703@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4704
4705On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4706not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4707they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4708appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4709registers are used in the function.
4710
4711@findex frame_pointer_needed
4712On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4713function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4714pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4715frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4716@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4717time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4718
4719The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4720required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4721listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4722order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4723stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4724the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4725for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4726compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4727or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4728need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
08c148a8
NB
4729@end deftypefn
4730
17b53c33
NB
4731@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4732If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4733prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4734emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4735emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4736@end deftypefn
4737
4738@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4739If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4740epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4741emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4742emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4743@end deftypefn
4744
08c148a8
NB
4745@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4746If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4747function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4748registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4749called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4750same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4751registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4752@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4753
4754On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4755of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4756instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4757@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4758
4759Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4760@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4761switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4762define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4763target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4764condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4765
4766On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4767function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4768two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4769is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4770@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4771a function that needs a frame pointer.
4772
4773Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4774@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4775The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4776function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4777
4778On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4779others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4780given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4781number of arguments.
4782
29454ff5
SL
4783@findex pops_args
4784@findex crtl->args.pops_args
08c148a8
NB
4785Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4786functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
72392b81
JR
4787needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4788function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4789@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
08c148a8
NB
4790@end deftypefn
4791
feca2ed3
JW
4792@itemize @bullet
4793@item
29454ff5
SL
4794@findex pretend_args_size
4795@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4796A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
feca2ed3
JW
4797uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4798stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4799if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4800arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4801yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4802region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4803registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
6c535c69 4804features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
feca2ed3
JW
4805
4806@item
4807An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4808The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4809the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4810machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4811in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4812a save area.
4813
4814@item
4815A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4816boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4817this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4818save area closer to the top of the stack.
4819
4820@item
4821@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4822Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
29454ff5 4823@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
feca2ed3
JW
4824argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4825@end itemize
4826
a2c4f8e0 4827@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
feca2ed3
JW
4828Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4829instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4830pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
9d05bbce
KH
4831adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4832default is 0.
feca2ed3
JW
4833
4834Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4835frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4836stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4837compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
a2c4f8e0 4838@end defmac
feca2ed3 4839
a2c4f8e0 4840@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
8760eaae 4841Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
feca2ed3 4842used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
86c33cd0 4843pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
a2c4f8e0 4844@end defmac
feca2ed3 4845
a2c4f8e0 4846@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
15b5aef3
RH
4847Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4848used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4849on entry to an exception edge.
a2c4f8e0 4850@end defmac
15b5aef3 4851
a2c4f8e0 4852@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4853Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4854instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4855definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4856representing the number of delay slots there.
a2c4f8e0 4857@end defmac
feca2ed3 4858
a2c4f8e0 4859@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
feca2ed3
JW
4860A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4861slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4862
4863The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4864being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4865eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4866of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4867If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4868may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4869(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4870slot.
4871
29454ff5
SL
4872@findex epilogue_delay_list
4873@findex crtl->epilogue_delay_list
feca2ed3
JW
4874@findex final_scan_insn
4875The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
29454ff5
SL
4876list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in
4877@code{crtl->epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
feca2ed3 4878delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
08c148a8
NB
4879@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4880outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4881@code{final_scan_insn}.
feca2ed3
JW
4882
4883You need not define this macro if you did not define
4884@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
a2c4f8e0 4885@end defmac
feca2ed3 4886
65e71cd6 4887@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
483ab821 4888A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
feca2ed3
JW
4889function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4890inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4891adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4892the real function.
4893
4894First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4895contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4896contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4897in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
e979f9e8 4898e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
feca2ed3
JW
4899all other incoming arguments.
4900
65e71cd6
EB
4901Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4902made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4903adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4904
4905@smallexample
4906p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4907@end smallexample
4908
4909After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
feca2ed3
JW
4910@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4911not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4912return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4913
4914The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4915the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
08c148a8
NB
4916of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4917and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
feca2ed3
JW
4918
4919The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4920have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4921some targets, but probably not.
4922
861bb6c1 4923If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
c771326b 4924front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
861bb6c1
JL
4925@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4926not support varargs.
483ab821
MM
4927@end deftypefn
4928
9ddb66ef 4929@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
65e71cd6
EB
4930A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4931to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4932arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4933generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4934previously exposed.
483ab821 4935@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4936
4937@node Profiling
4938@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4939@cindex profiling, code generation
4940
4941These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4942
a2c4f8e0 4943@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
feca2ed3
JW
4944A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4945assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
feca2ed3
JW
4946
4947@findex mcount
980e2067 4948The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
161d7b59 4949your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
980e2067
JL
4950compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4951compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4952
4953Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4954variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4955@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4956the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
a2c4f8e0 4957@end defmac
980e2067 4958
a2c4f8e0 4959@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
411707f4
CC
4960A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4961code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4962not support profiling.
a2c4f8e0 4963@end defmac
411707f4 4964
a2c4f8e0 4965@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
8b65a354
JZ
4966Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4967@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4968allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4969implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4970@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
a2c4f8e0 4971@end defmac
feca2ed3 4972
a2c4f8e0 4973@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4974Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4975the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
a2c4f8e0 4976@end defmac
feca2ed3 4977
91d231cb
JM
4978@node Tail Calls
4979@subsection Permitting tail calls
4980@cindex tail calls
b36f4ed3 4981
4977bab6
ZW
4982@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4983True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4984call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4985or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4cb1433c
RH
4986
4987It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4988tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4977bab6 4989during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
02f52e19 4990as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4977bab6
ZW
4991``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4992may vary greatly between different architectures.
4993@end deftypefn
4cb1433c 4994
9ddb66ef 4995@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
912f2dac
DB
4996Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4997function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4998cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4999registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
5000TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
5001FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
5002@end deftypefn
5003
ee3d2ecd
JJ
5004@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
5005This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
5006@end deftypefn
5007
d45eae79
SL
5008@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
5009True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
5010@end deftypefn
5011
7d69de61
RH
5012@node Stack Smashing Protection
5013@subsection Stack smashing protection
5014@cindex stack smashing protection
5015
5016@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5017This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
083cad55 5018for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
7d69de61
RH
5019runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5020that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5021variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5022
5023The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5024@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5025@end deftypefn
5026
5027@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
b3c144a3 5028This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
7d69de61
RH
5029stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5030involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5031
5032The default version of this hook invokes a function called
083cad55 5033@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
7d69de61
RH
5034normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5035@end deftypefn
5036
677f3fa8 5037@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
d5fabb58 5038Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
7458026b
ILT
5039@end deftypefn
5040
feca2ed3
JW
5041@node Varargs
5042@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5043@cindex varargs implementation
5044
aee96fe9
JM
5045GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5046@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
feca2ed3
JW
5047on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5048varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5049conditionals to include it.
5050
aee96fe9 5051ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
feca2ed3
JW
5052the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5053implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5490d604 5054to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
feca2ed3
JW
5055@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5056supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5057
5058However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5059the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5060below.
5061
a2c4f8e0 5062@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
feca2ed3 5063Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5490d604 5064that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
feca2ed3 5065versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
c2379679 5066you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
feca2ed3
JW
5067
5068On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
f61c92c3
KH
5069control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5070other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5071found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
feca2ed3
JW
5072
5073Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5074beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5075@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5076This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5077to use them for its own purposes.
5078@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5079@c 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 5080@end defmac
feca2ed3 5081
a2c4f8e0 5082@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 5083This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
767094dd 5084argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
feca2ed3
JW
5085returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5086argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5087fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5088verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5089of the current function.
a2c4f8e0 5090@end defmac
feca2ed3 5091
a2c4f8e0 5092@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
feca2ed3
JW
5093Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5094passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5095has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5096specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5097with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5098
5099@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5100considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5101kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5102
5103The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5104interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
a2c4f8e0 5105@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5106
5107These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5108
61f71b34
DD
5109@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5110If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5111@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5112beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5113return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5114to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5115@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5116
d5cc9181 5117@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
61f71b34
DD
5118This target hook offers an alternative to using
5119@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5120@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5121register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5122have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5123use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5124pass all their arguments on the stack.
feca2ed3 5125
61f71b34 5126The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
8760eaae 5127structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
feca2ed3
JW
5128named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5129last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5130
61f71b34
DD
5131The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5132argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5133store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5134variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5135store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5136frame.
feca2ed3
JW
5137
5138Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5139compile time without knowing their data types,
61f71b34
DD
5140@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5141have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5142for all data types.
feca2ed3
JW
5143
5144If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5145arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5146happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
61f71b34 5147end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
feca2ed3 5148not generate any instructions in this case.
61f71b34 5149@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5150
d5cc9181 5151@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
61f71b34 5152Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
e5e809f4 5153argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
feca2ed3 5154
b25b9e8f 5155This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
61f71b34
DD
5156is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5157@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5158arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5b4ef0b1 5159but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
61f71b34
DD
5160then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5161except the last are treated as named.
e5e809f4 5162
9ddb66ef 5163You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
61f71b34 5164@end deftypefn
9ab70a9b 5165
d5cc9181 5166@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
9ab70a9b 5167If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
61f71b34
DD
5168@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5169@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5170defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
c2379679 5171@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
61f71b34
DD
5172Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5173@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5174
5175@node Trampolines
5176@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5177@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5178@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5179
5180A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5181when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5182the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
a3a15b4d 5183tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
feca2ed3
JW
5184trampoline.
5185
5186The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5187address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5188the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5189two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5190exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5191machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5192two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5193operands.
5194
5195The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5196parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5197immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5198simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5199proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5200may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5201separately.
5202
531ca746
RH
5203@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5204This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5205on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5206the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5207label---the label is taken care of automatically.
feca2ed3 5208
531ca746
RH
5209If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5210for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
feca2ed3
JW
5211code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5212to generate it on the spot.
531ca746 5213@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5214
a2c4f8e0 5215@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
d6b5193b
RS
5216Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5217(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
a2c4f8e0 5218@end defmac
feca2ed3 5219
a2c4f8e0 5220@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
feca2ed3 5221A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
a2c4f8e0 5222@end defmac
feca2ed3 5223
a2c4f8e0 5224@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
5225Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5226
531ca746 5227If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
feca2ed3 5228is used for aligning trampolines.
a2c4f8e0 5229@end defmac
feca2ed3 5230
531ca746
RH
5231@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5232This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5233@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5234is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
feca2ed3
JW
5235RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5236when it is called.
5237
531ca746
RH
5238If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5239first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5240from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5241Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
531ca746
RH
5242trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5243to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
b33493e3 5244
531ca746 5245If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5246enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
531ca746
RH
5247initializing the trampoline proper.
5248@end deftypefn
5249
5250@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5251This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5252the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5253memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5254the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5255address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5256be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5257If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5258@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5259
5260Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5261separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5262fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5263jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5264
5265Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5266the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5267make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5268subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5269latter makes initialization faster.
5270
5271To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
f691dc3b 5272the following macro.
feca2ed3 5273
a2c4f8e0 5274@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
feca2ed3 5275If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
f691dc3b
AJ
5276cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5277typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5278@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
a2c4f8e0 5279@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5280
5281To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5282you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5283cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5284beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5285its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5286
a2c4f8e0 5287@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
feca2ed3
JW
5288Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5289work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
161d7b59 5290which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
feca2ed3
JW
5291@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5292
5293If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5294C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5295special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5296statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5297global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5298special assembler code.
a2c4f8e0 5299@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5300
5301@node Library Calls
5302@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5303@cindex library subroutine names
5304@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5305
5306@c prevent bad page break with this line
5307Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5308
a2c4f8e0 5309@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
d8088c6f
BS
5310This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5311expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
2dd76960 5312provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
d8088c6f 5313are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
a2c4f8e0 5314@end defmac
d8088c6f 5315
c15c90bb 5316@findex set_optab_libfunc
914d25dc 5317@findex init_one_libfunc
c15c90bb
ZW
5318@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5319This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5320existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5321@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5322@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5323library routines.
feca2ed3 5324
c15c90bb
ZW
5325The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5326@end deftypefn
c5c60e15 5327
cdbf4541
BS
5328@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5329If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5330underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5331instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5332currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5333is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5334@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5335@end deftypevr
5336
9c917669 5337@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
c15c90bb
ZW
5338This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5339implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5340mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5341return a tristate.
5342
5343GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5344comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5345don't need to define this macro.
5346@end defmac
5347
b3f8d95d
MM
5348@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5349This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5350functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5351operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5352and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
38b974a6 5353If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
78466c0e 5354@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
b3f8d95d
MM
5355in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5356@end defmac
5357
feca2ed3 5358@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5359@findex matherr
5360@defmac TARGET_EDOM
feca2ed3 5361The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
a3a15b4d 5362expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
feca2ed3
JW
5363deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5364@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5365system.
5366
5367If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5368domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5369error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5370there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5371that @code{matherr} is used normally.
a2c4f8e0 5372@end defmac
feca2ed3 5373
feca2ed3 5374@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5375@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
feca2ed3
JW
5376Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5377refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5378@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5379macro, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 5380@end defmac
feca2ed3 5381
272f51a3 5382@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5383@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
272f51a3 5384When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
3bcf1b13 5385@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5472de36
SE
5386default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5387functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5388systems that do support the C99 runtime.
a2c4f8e0 5389@end defmac
272f51a3 5390
006339cd
RG
5391@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5392@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5393When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5394and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5395default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5396@smallexample
5397void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5398void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5399void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5400@end smallexample
5401@end defmac
5402
a2c4f8e0 5403@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5404Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5405by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5406and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5407This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5408the NeXT runtime installed.
5409
5410If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5411will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5412selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5413
5414In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5415scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
a2c4f8e0 5416@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5417
5418@node Addressing Modes
5419@section Addressing Modes
5420@cindex addressing modes
5421
5422@c prevent bad page break with this line
5423This is about addressing modes.
5424
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5425@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5426@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5427@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5428@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
df2a54e9 5429A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
7a6bd5ae 5430pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
a2c4f8e0 5431@end defmac
feca2ed3 5432
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5433@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5434@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
df2a54e9 5435A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae
JL
5436post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5437the size of the memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 5438@end defmac
864bcaa7 5439
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5440@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5441@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
df2a54e9 5442A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae 5443post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
a2c4f8e0 5444@end defmac
864bcaa7 5445
a2c4f8e0 5446@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3 5447A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
65a324b4
NC
5448is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5449@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5450is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5451constant addresses are supported.
a2c4f8e0 5452@end defmac
feca2ed3 5453
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5454@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5455@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5456accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5457known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5458expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5459@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5460@end defmac
feca2ed3 5461
a2c4f8e0 5462@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
feca2ed3
JW
5463A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5464memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
c6c3dba9 5465the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
feca2ed3 5466accept.
a2c4f8e0 5467@end defmac
feca2ed3 5468
914d25dc 5469@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
c6c3dba9
PB
5470A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5471address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3 5472
c6c3dba9 5473Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
914d25dc 5474non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
c6c3dba9 5475desired by the caller.
feca2ed3 5476
c6c3dba9
PB
5477The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5478that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5479considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5480kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5481must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5482up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5483register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5484if the array holds @code{-1}.
feca2ed3
JW
5485
5486The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5487accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5488register is required.
5489
feca2ed3
JW
5490Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5491and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5492constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5493specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5494recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5495
5496Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5497sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5498@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5499naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5500be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5501
fb49053f 5502@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
feca2ed3
JW
5503On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5504the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
fb49053f
RH
5505target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5506into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
feca2ed3
JW
5507@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5508@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5509Format}.
c6c3dba9
PB
5510
5511@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5512Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5513this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5514has this syntax:
5515
5516@example
5517#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5518@end example
5519
5520@noindent
5521and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5522address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5523
5524@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5525Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5526macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5527@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5528that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5529
c6c3dba9
PB
5530Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5531files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5532@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5533
a4edaf83
AK
5534@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5535A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5536character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5537letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
c6c3dba9 5538@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
a4edaf83
AK
5539support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5540semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5541preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5542@code{'m'} constraint.
5543@end defmac
5544
a2c4f8e0 5545@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
a9e6fc5a
RS
5546A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5547or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
53451050
RS
5548can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5549@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
b949ea8b
JW
5550
5551It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5552that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5553
5554The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
161d7b59 5555a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 5556@end defmac
b949ea8b 5557
506d7b68
PB
5558@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5559This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5560operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5561address.
feca2ed3
JW
5562
5563@findex break_out_memory_refs
5564@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5565and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5566@var{x}.
5567
506d7b68 5568The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
feca2ed3 5569@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
506d7b68 5570should return the new @var{x}.
feca2ed3 5571
f938987f
HPN
5572It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5573with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5574The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5575the target supports only emulated TLS, it
506d7b68
PB
5576is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5577a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5578strategy can generate better code.
5579@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5580
a2c4f8e0 5581@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
a9a2595b
JR
5582A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5583that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5584@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5585It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
02f52e19 5586performance reasons.
a9a2595b
JR
5587
5588For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5589reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5590registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5591processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5592needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
aee96fe9 5593@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
a9a2595b
JR
5594generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5595be shared.
5596
39bdfaa0
RH
5597@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5598to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5599and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5600of reload internals.
a9a2595b 5601
5f0c590d
JL
5602@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5603previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5604then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5605
a9a2595b 5606@findex push_reload
39bdfaa0
RH
5607The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5608need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5609suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
a9a2595b 5610
39bdfaa0 5611The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
a9a2595b
JR
5612@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5613should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5614This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5615@code{push_reload}.
5616
39bdfaa0
RH
5617@findex strict_memory_address_p
5618The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5619the address has become legitimate.
5620
a9a2595b
JR
5621@findex copy_rtx
5622If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
ab873839 5623this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
a9a2595b 5624single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
c771326b 5625top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
a9a2595b
JR
5626It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5627address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
a2c4f8e0 5628@end defmac
a9a2595b 5629
5bfed9a9
GJL
5630@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5631This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5632space @var{addrspace} can have
cbda7dc6
AS
5633different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5634reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5635but not others.
5636
5637Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5638effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5639of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5640addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5641
5642You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5643
5644The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5645@end deftypefn
5646
1a627b35
RS
5647@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5648This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5649@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5650@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5651
5652The default definition returns true.
5653@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5654
73f8783a
RS
5655@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5656This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5657@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5658macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5659references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5660addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5661the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5662into their original form.
5663@end deftypefn
93bcc8c9
JJ
5664
5665@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5666This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5667debug sections.
5668@end deftypefn
73f8783a 5669
fbbf66e7 5670@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
d3da4d14 5671This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5672should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5673of @var{x}.
5674
5675The default version of this hook returns false.
d3da4d14
RH
5676
5677The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5678deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5679from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5680holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5681of TLS symbols for various targets.
5682@end deftypefn
5683
b6fd8800 5684@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885
RS
5685This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5686be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5687of @var{x}.
5688
5689The default version returns false for all constants.
5690@end deftypefn
5691
5eb7ce91 5692@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
6b889d89 5693This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
ac10986f 5694the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5eb7ce91 5695@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
ac10986f
UB
5696when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5697@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5698of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5699function are valid.
6b889d89
UB
5700@end deftypefn
5701
d16b59fa
DN
5702@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5703This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5704address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
083cad55 5705used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
d16b59fa
DN
5706@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5707
ab873839 5708The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
d16b59fa
DN
5709@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5710the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5711@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5712two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5713@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5714the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5715from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
083cad55
EC
5716@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5717@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
d16b59fa
DN
5718@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5719
5720If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5721to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5722use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5723@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
083cad55 5724should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
d16b59fa
DN
5725described above.
5726If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5727the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
8ad1dde7 5728log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
d16b59fa
DN
5729@end deftypefn
5730
720f5239 5731@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
35e1a5e7 5732Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5733For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5734misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
a934eb2d
JR
5735@end deftypefn
5736
5737@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5738Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5739@end deftypefn
5740
22e4dee7 5741@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5dea5b2a 5742Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
a934eb2d
JR
5743@end deftypefn
5744
88dd7150 5745@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
f57d17f1 5746This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
88dd7150 5747input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
a934eb2d
JR
5748The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5749specifies how the conversion is to be applied
f57d17f1
TM
5750(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5751
5752If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5753@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5754conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5755@end deftypefn
5756
62f7fd21
MM
5757@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5758This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5759vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5760@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5761The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5762return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5763@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
2505a3f2
RG
5764@end deftypefn
5765
38f8b050 5766@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
0601d0cf
RE
5767This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5768store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5769parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5770the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5771parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5772@end deftypefn
5773
cc4b5170
RG
5774@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5775This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5776mode @var{mode}. The default is
5777equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5778transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5779@end deftypefn
5780
767f865f
RG
5781@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5782This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5783after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5784mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5785The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5786@end deftypefn
5787
c3e7ee41 5788@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
92345349 5789This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
c3e7ee41
BS
5790@end deftypefn
5791
92345349
BS
5792@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5793This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
c3e7ee41
BS
5794@end deftypefn
5795
92345349
BS
5796@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5797This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
c3e7ee41
BS
5798@end deftypefn
5799
5800@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5801This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5802@end deftypefn
5803
0a35513e
AH
5804@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5805This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5806@end deftypefn
5807
5808@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5809This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5810@end deftypefn
5811
aec7ae7d
JJ
5812@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5813Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5814is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5815the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5816The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5817loads.
5818@end deftypefn
5819
aacd3885
RS
5820@node Anchored Addresses
5821@section Anchored Addresses
5822@cindex anchored addresses
5823@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5824
5825GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5826For example, if we have:
5827
5828@smallexample
5829static int a, b, c;
5830int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5831@end smallexample
5832
5833the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5834addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5835it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5836the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5837be something like:
5838
5839@smallexample
5840int foo (void)
5841@{
5842 register int *xr = &x;
5843 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5844@}
5845@end smallexample
5846
5847(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5848``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5849
5850The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5851in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5852section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5853or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5854
9e3be889 5855@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5856The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5857On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5858applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5859for every mode. The default value is 0.
9e3be889 5860@end deftypevr
aacd3885 5861
9e3be889 5862@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5863Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5864offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5865value is 0.
9e3be889 5866@end deftypevr
aacd3885
RS
5867
5868@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5869Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5870@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5871The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5872of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5873
5874If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5875it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5876If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5877is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5878@end deftypefn
5879
b6fd8800 5880@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885 5881Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3fa9c136 5882@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
aacd3885
RS
5883@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5884
5885The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5886intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5887or target-specific sections.
5888@end deftypefn
5889
feca2ed3
JW
5890@node Condition Code
5891@section Condition Code Status
5892@cindex condition code status
5893
f90b7a5a
PB
5894The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5895two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5896
5897The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5898(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5899clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5900register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5901architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5902most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5903most RISC machines.
5904
5905The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5906the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5907insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5908optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5909is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5910three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5911scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5912separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5913
5914For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5915represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5916condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5917condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5918or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5919Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5920that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5921
5922Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5923specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5924interested in most macros in this section.
5925
5926@menu
5927* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5928* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5929* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
f90b7a5a
PB
5930@end menu
5931
5932@node CC0 Condition Codes
5933@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5934@findex cc0
feca2ed3
JW
5935
5936@findex cc_status
5937The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5938describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5939the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5940variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5941currently based, and several standard flags.
5942
5943Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5944description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5945information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5946
a2c4f8e0 5947@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
feca2ed3
JW
5948C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5949component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5950
5951This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5952@end defmac
feca2ed3 5953
a2c4f8e0 5954@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
feca2ed3
JW
5955A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5956The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5957the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5958define this macro to initialize it.
5959
5960This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5961@end defmac
feca2ed3 5962
a2c4f8e0 5963@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
5964A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5965appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5966this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5967code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5968set @code{(cc0)}.
5969
5970This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5971
5972If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5973other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5974invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5975reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5976registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5977@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5978insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5979based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5980value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5981this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5982@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5983@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5984condition code value.
5985
5986The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5987with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5988@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5989constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5990insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5991@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5992@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5993
5994A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5995that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5996@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5997two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
a2c4f8e0 5998@end defmac
feca2ed3 5999
f90b7a5a
PB
6000@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6001@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6002@findex CCmode
6003@findex MODE_CC
6004
a2c4f8e0 6005@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
f90b7a5a
PB
6006On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6007than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6008code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6009when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6010bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6011branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6012this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6013record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6014also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6015unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6016
6017If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6018@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6019a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6020have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6021by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6022be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6023the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6024
6025@smallexample
6026(define_insn ""
6027 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6028 (compare:CC_NOOV
6029 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6030 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6031 (const_int 0)))]
6032 ""
6033 "@dots{}")
6034@end smallexample
6035
6036@noindent
6037together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6038for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
feca2ed3
JW
6039
6040@smallexample
6041#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6042 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6043 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6044 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6045 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6046 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6047@end smallexample
6048
f90b7a5a
PB
6049Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6050were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6051this section.
6052
94134f42
ZW
6053You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6054in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
a2c4f8e0 6055@end defmac
feca2ed3 6056
a2c4f8e0 6057@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
8760eaae 6058On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
feca2ed3
JW
6059convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6060does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6061comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6062
6063On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6064required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6065and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6066comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6067@var{op1} as required.
6068
a3a15b4d 6069GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
6070valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6071@file{md} file.
6072
6073You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6074code or operands.
a2c4f8e0 6075@end defmac
feca2ed3 6076
a2c4f8e0 6077@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
6078A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6079comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6080can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6081then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6082
6083You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6084floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
981f6289 6085For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
feca2ed3
JW
6086inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6087
6088@smallexample
6089#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6090@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6091@end defmac
feca2ed3 6092
a2c4f8e0 6093@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
9e7adcb3
JH
6094A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6095comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6096@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6097machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6098instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6099freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6100like:
6101
6102@smallexample
6103#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
c771326b 6104 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
9e7adcb3
JH
6105 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6106@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6107@end defmac
9e7adcb3 6108
ab7e224a 6109@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
e129d93a
ILT
6110On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6111register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6112regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6113hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6114small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6115to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6116arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6117When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
ab7e224a 6118integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
e129d93a
ILT
6119@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6120
6121The default version of this hook returns false.
6122@end deftypefn
6123
ab7e224a 6124@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
e129d93a
ILT
6125On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6126@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6127validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6128target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6129both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6130return @code{VOIDmode}.
6131
6132The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6133same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6134returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6135@end deftypefn
6136
ac7eb5c6 6137@node Cond Exec Macros
f90b7a5a
PB
6138@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6139@findex conditional execution
6140@findex predication
6141
6142There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6143supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6144represent conditional branches.
6145
feca2ed3
JW
6146@node Costs
6147@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6148@cindex costs of instructions
6149@cindex relative costs
6150@cindex speed of instructions
6151
6152These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6153on the target machine.
6154
a2c4f8e0 6155@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
e56b4594
AO
6156A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6157register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6158expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6159value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6160that.
feca2ed3
JW
6161
6162It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6163same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6164registers if they are not general registers.
6165
6166If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6167hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6168classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6169constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6170allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6171if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
de8f4b07
AS
6172
6173These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6174@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6175@end defmac
feca2ed3 6176
a87cf97e 6177@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
de8f4b07
AS
6178This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6179from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6180are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6181A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6182that.
6183
6184It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6185same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6186registers if they are not general registers.
6187
6188If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6189hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6190classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6191constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6192allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6193if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6194
6195The default version of this function returns 2.
6196@end deftypefn
6197
a2c4f8e0 6198@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
cbd5b9a2
KR
6199A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6200register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
df2a54e9 6201is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
473fe49b
KR
6202is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6203registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6204should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6205
a3a15b4d 6206If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
38e01259 6207the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
473fe49b
KR
6208needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6209between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6210more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6211reflect the actual cost of the move.
6212
a3a15b4d 6213GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
473fe49b
KR
6214secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6215a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6216secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62174 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6218value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6219are the same as to this macro.
f5c21ef3
AS
6220
6221These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6222@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6223@end defmac
cbd5b9a2 6224
a87cf97e 6225@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
f5c21ef3 6226This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6227between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
f5c21ef3 6228if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
de8f4b07
AS
6229This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6230If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6231registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
f5c21ef3
AS
6232
6233If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6234the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6235needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6236between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
f5c21ef3
AS
6237more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6238reflect the actual cost of the move.
6239
6240GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6241secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6242a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6243secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62444 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6245value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6246are the same as to this target hook.
6247@end deftypefn
6248
3a4fd356 6249@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6250A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6251the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6252@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6253for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6254optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6255true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6256@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
a2c4f8e0 6257@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
6258
6259Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
a3a15b4d 6260but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
feca2ed3
JW
6261ordinarily expect.
6262
a2c4f8e0 6263@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
feca2ed3 6264Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
e979f9e8 6265than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
feca2ed3
JW
6266faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6267require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6268between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6269
6270When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6271finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6272load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6273faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6274may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6275other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
a2c4f8e0 6276@end defmac
feca2ed3 6277
a2c4f8e0 6278@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5fad8ebf
DE
6279Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6280@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6281than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6282handler.
feca2ed3 6283
df2a54e9
JM
6284When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6285@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
feca2ed3 6286moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
df2a54e9 6287Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
feca2ed3
JW
6288cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6289
6be57663 6290If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
df2a54e9
JM
6291this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6292@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
a2c4f8e0 6293@end defmac
feca2ed3 6294
65a324b4 6295@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
9862dea9 6296The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
c5c76735 6297which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
feca2ed3
JW
6298string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6299make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6300
c5c76735
JL
6301Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6302@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6303the number of such sequences.
9862dea9 6304
65a324b4
NC
6305The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6306optimized for speed rather than size.
6307
feca2ed3 6308If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6309@end defmac
feca2ed3 6310
a2c4f8e0 6311@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
fbe1758d
AM
6312A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6313copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6e01bd94 6314will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
fbe1758d 6315than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6316@end defmac
fbe1758d 6317
a2c4f8e0 6318@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
fbe1758d 6319A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6e01bd94 6320a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
a2c4f8e0 6321@end defmac
fbe1758d 6322
65a324b4 6323@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
78762e3b
RS
6324The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6325of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6326or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6327eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6328
65a324b4
NC
6329The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6330optimized for speed rather than size.
6331
78762e3b 6332If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6333@end defmac
78762e3b 6334
a2c4f8e0 6335@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
78762e3b
RS
6336A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6337to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6338will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6339than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6340@end defmac
78762e3b 6341
65a324b4 6342@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
cfa31150
SL
6343The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6344of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6345a block set insn or a library call.
cfa31150
SL
6346Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6347eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6348
65a324b4
NC
6349The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6350optimized for speed rather than size.
6351
cfa31150
SL
6352If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6353@end defmac
6354
6355@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6356A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6357used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6358other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
cfa31150
SL
6359storing values other than constant zero.
6360Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6361than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6362@end defmac
6363
a2c4f8e0 6364@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
4977bab6 6365A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
65a324b4 6366used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
cfa31150
SL
6367other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6368called with a constant source string.
0bdcd332 6369Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
45d78e7f 6370than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
a2c4f8e0 6371@end defmac
4977bab6 6372
a2c4f8e0 6373@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6374A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6375thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6377@end defmac
6e01bd94 6378
a2c4f8e0 6379@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6380A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6381thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6383@end defmac
fbe1758d 6384
a2c4f8e0 6385@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6386A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6387thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6389@end defmac
6e01bd94 6390
a2c4f8e0 6391@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6392A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6393thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6394@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6395@end defmac
fbe1758d 6396
a2c4f8e0 6397@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6398A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6399thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6400@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6401@end defmac
6e01bd94 6402
a2c4f8e0 6403@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c771326b 6404A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6e01bd94
MH
6405thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6406@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6407@end defmac
fbe1758d 6408
a2c4f8e0 6409@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6410This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6411thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6412@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6413@end defmac
6e01bd94 6414
a2c4f8e0 6415@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6416This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6417thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6418@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6419@end defmac
fbe1758d 6420
a2c4f8e0 6421@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
feca2ed3
JW
6422Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6423function address than to call an address kept in a register.
a2c4f8e0 6424@end defmac
feca2ed3 6425
a8d56c30
SB
6426@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6427Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6428@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6429@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6430@end defmac
6431
68f932c4 6432@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
3c50106f
RH
6433This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6434
6435The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6436available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6437as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6438That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6439that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6440either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6441(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6442
6443@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6444obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
3c50106f
RH
6445
6446In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6447@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6448instructions.
6449
6450On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6451for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
31a52b86
RS
6452necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6453for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6454operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6455
65a324b4
NC
6456When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6457false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
31a52b86 6458size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
3c50106f
RH
6459
6460The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6461processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6462@end deftypefn
6463
b413068c 6464@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
10154ff8
RH
6465This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6466@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6467the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6468
6469For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6470true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6471instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6472all addresses will have equal costs.
6473
6474In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6475the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6476cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6477
6478For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6479and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6480is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6481references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6482the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6483that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6484instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6485specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6486
6487This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6488
6489On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6490cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6491@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6492be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6493@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6494should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6495should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6496registers on machines with lots of registers.
6497@end deftypefn
6498
c237e94a
ZW
6499@node Scheduling
6500@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6501
6502The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6503adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6504hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6505them: try the first ones in this list first.
6506
6507@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
fae15c93
VM
6508This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6509issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6510Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6511an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6512constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6513hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6514This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6515it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
c237e94a
ZW
6516@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6517@end deftypefn
6518
6519@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6520This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6521from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
3ee04299
DE
6522still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6523@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6524@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6525You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6526than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6527@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6528debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6529@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6530was scheduled.
c237e94a
ZW
6531@end deftypefn
6532
6533@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
fae15c93
VM
6534This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6535relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6536dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6537is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6538to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
c237e94a 6539that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
fae15c93
VM
6540data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6541description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6542output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6543times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6544acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
fa0aee89 6545@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
c237e94a
ZW
6546@end deftypefn
6547
6548@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6549This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
496d7bb0
MK
6550@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6551execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
c237e94a
ZW
6552later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6553scheduling priorities of insns.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6557This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6558list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6559combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6560@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6561debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6562@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6563list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6564a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6565reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
65a324b4 6566@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
c237e94a
ZW
6567is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6568the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6569can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6570@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6571@end deftypefn
6572
914d25dc 6573@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6574Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6575function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6576is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6577@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6578return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6579this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6580scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6581cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6582@end deftypefn
6583
30028c85
VM
6584@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6585This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6586chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6587correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6588example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6589analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6590dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6591calculated.
6592@end deftypefn
6593
c237e94a
ZW
6594@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6595This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6596instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6597pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6598is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6599@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6600region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
431ae0bf 6601scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
c237e94a
ZW
6602@end deftypefn
6603
6604@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6605This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6606instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6607cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6608is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6609to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6610@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6611@end deftypefn
6612
58565a33
SKG
6613@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6614This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6615@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6616@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6617@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6618@end deftypefn
6619
6620@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
8a36672b 6621This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
58565a33
SKG
6622@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6623@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6624@end deftypefn
6625
914d25dc 6626@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6627The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6628pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6629when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6630simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6631processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6632based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6633when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6634@end deftypefn
6635
6636@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6637The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6638@end deftypefn
6639
914d25dc 6640@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6641The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6642to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6643simulated processor cycle finishes.
6644@end deftypefn
6645
6646@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6647The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6648used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6649@end deftypefn
6650
914d25dc 6651@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6652The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6653The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6654to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6655state on a single insn is not enough.
6656@end deftypefn
6657
914d25dc 6658@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6659The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6660The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6661to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6662state on a single insn is not enough.
6663@end deftypefn
6664
fae15c93
VM
6665@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6666This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6667for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6668chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6669value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6670@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6671subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6672maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6673@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6674packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6675rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6676
6677This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6678processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6679with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6680@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6681@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6682processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6683@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6684until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6685the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6686
6687Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6688pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6689schedules to choose the best one.
6690
6691The default is no multipass scheduling.
6692@end deftypefn
6693
914d25dc 6694@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
30028c85
VM
6695
6696This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6697considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
914d25dc 6698zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
30028c85
VM
6699be issued.
6700
62b9c42c 6701The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
30028c85
VM
6702@end deftypefn
6703
894fd6f2
MK
6704@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6705This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6706scheduling.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6710This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6711@end deftypefn
6712
6713@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6714This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6715an instruction.
6716@end deftypefn
6717
6718@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6719This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6720round of multipass scheduling.
6721@end deftypefn
6722
6723@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6724This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6725@end deftypefn
6726
6727@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6728This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6729@end deftypefn
6730
a934eb2d 6731@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
a934eb2d
JR
6732This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6733on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6734@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6735the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6736is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6737start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6738verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6739@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6740processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6741and the current processor cycle.
30028c85
VM
6742@end deftypefn
6743
72392b81 6744@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
569fa502 6745This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
daf2f129 6746the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
569fa502 6747are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
b198261f
MK
6748to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6749being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
72392b81 6750dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
daf2f129 6751parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
569fa502
DN
6752The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6753insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6754and @code{false} otherwise.
6755
6756Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
daf2f129 6757where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
569fa502 6758delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
daf2f129 6759that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
569fa502 6760important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
78466c0e 6761closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
72392b81 6762not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
569fa502
DN
6763@end deftypefn
6764
496d7bb0
MK
6765@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6766This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6767the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6768per instruction data structures.
6769@end deftypefn
6770
b6fd8800 6771@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e855c69d
AB
6772Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6773@end deftypefn
6774
6775@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6776Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6777It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
ab7e224a 6778beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e855c69d
AB
6779@end deftypefn
6780
6781@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
914d25dc 6782Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e855c69d
AB
6783@end deftypefn
6784
6785@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6786Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6787@end deftypefn
6788
6789@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6790Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6791@end deftypefn
6792
496d7bb0 6793@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
64ee9490
EC
6794This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6795speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6796The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6797version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6798pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
8ad1dde7 6799or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
496d7bb0
MK
6800speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6801the generated speculative pattern.
6802@end deftypefn
6803
72392b81 6804@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
496d7bb0 6805This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
72392b81
JR
6806for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6807instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
496d7bb0
MK
6808@end deftypefn
6809
914d25dc 6810@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
496d7bb0 6811This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
64ee9490
EC
6812check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6813speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6814@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6815be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6816recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6817a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
496d7bb0
MK
6818@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6819@end deftypefn
6820
5498b6d2 6821@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
496d7bb0
MK
6822This hook is used as a workaround for
6823@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6824called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
5498b6d2
JR
6825discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6826being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6827@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6828For non-speculative instructions,
6829the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
496d7bb0
MK
6830the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6831is nearly full.
6832@end deftypefn
6833
50e87e30 6834@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
64ee9490 6835This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
50e87e30
JR
6836enabled/used.
6837The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
496d7bb0
MK
6838The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6839@end deftypefn
6840
67186a97
TS
6841@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6842This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6843resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6844the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6845backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6846bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6847of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6848@end deftypefn
6849
7942e47e
RY
6850@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6851This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6852is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6853@end deftypefn
6854
6855@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6856This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6857in its second parameter.
6858@end deftypefn
6859
b0bd15f7
BS
6860@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6861True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6862the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6863also the latencies of operations.
6864@end deftypevr
6865
df7b0cc4
EI
6866@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6867This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6868parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6869@end deftypefn
6870
feca2ed3
JW
6871@node Sections
6872@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6873@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6874@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6875
6876An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6877data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6878section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6879section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6880section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6881of sections.
6882
d6b5193b
RS
6883@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6884@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6885The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6886is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6887as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6888initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6889They may however depend on command-line flags.
6890
6891@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6892use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6893to be string literals.
6894
6895Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6896section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6897should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6898@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6899
6900You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6901@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6902in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6903@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6904create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6905reuse @code{text_section}.
6906
6907All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6908if the target does not provide them.
feca2ed3 6909
a2c4f8e0 6910@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6911A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6912assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6913Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6914@end defmac
33c09f2f 6915
a2c4f8e0 6916@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6917If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6918frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6919a default definition if the target supports named sections.
a2c4f8e0 6920@end defmac
194734e9 6921
a2c4f8e0 6922@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
6923If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6924executed functions in the program.
a2c4f8e0 6925@end defmac
194734e9 6926
a2c4f8e0 6927@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6928A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6929assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6930data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 6931@end defmac
feca2ed3 6932
d6b5193b
RS
6933@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6934If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6935containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6936initialized, writable small data.
6937@end defmac
6938
a2c4f8e0 6939@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
d48bc59a
RH
6940A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6941assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6942data.
a2c4f8e0 6943@end defmac
d48bc59a 6944
a2c4f8e0 6945@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6946If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6947containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
ddf72388 6948uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
07c5f94e 6949@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
047c1c92 6950uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
630d3d5a 6951@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
047c1c92 6952used.
a2c4f8e0 6953@end defmac
feca2ed3 6954
d6b5193b
RS
6955@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6956If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6957containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6958uninitialized, writable small data.
6959@end defmac
6960
9b7e6950
RO
6961@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6962If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6963assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6964common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6965@end defmac
6966
6967@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6968If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6969containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6970default is @code{'T'}.
6971@end defmac
6972
a2c4f8e0 6973@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6974If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6975containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6976initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6977not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6978variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6979@end defmac
feca2ed3 6980
a2c4f8e0 6981@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6982If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6983containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6984finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
6985not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6986variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 6987@end defmac
750054a2 6988
7abc66b1
JB
6989@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6990If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6991containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6992part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6993defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6994both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6995@end defmac
083cad55 6996
7abc66b1
JB
6997@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6998If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6999containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7000part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7001defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7002both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7003@end defmac
7004
a2c4f8e0 7005@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
cea3bd3e
RH
7006If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7007via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7008the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7009@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7010to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7011sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
1b2dd04a
AO
7012ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7013registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7014constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 7015@end defmac
1b2dd04a 7016
a0cfeb0f
DD
7017@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7018If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7019variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7020when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7021you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7022they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7023expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7024MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7025require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7026to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7027access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
726e9992 7028@end defmac
a0cfeb0f 7029
a2c4f8e0 7030@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
cea3bd3e
RH
7031If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7032arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7033@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7034and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
a2c4f8e0 7035@end defmac
cea3bd3e 7036
a2c4f8e0 7037@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
df2a54e9 7038Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
75197b37
BS
7039tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7040section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7041readonly data section is used.
feca2ed3
JW
7042
7043This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
a2c4f8e0 7044@end defmac
feca2ed3 7045
d6b5193b
RS
7046@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7047Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7048@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7049of its own that you need to create.
7050
7051GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7052any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7053described below.
7054@end deftypefn
7055
914d25dc 7056@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
9b580a0b
RH
7057Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7058selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7059should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7060local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7061
7062The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7063is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7064when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7065in read-only sections even in executables.
7066@end deftypefn
7067
d6b5193b
RS
7068@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7069Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
ae46c4e0
RH
7070assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7071some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7072requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7073local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
d6b5193b 7074@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
ae46c4e0
RH
7075
7076The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7077variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
09afda70
GK
7078
7079See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
ae46c4e0
RH
7080@end deftypefn
7081
09afda70
GK
7082@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7083Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7084for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7085
7086In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7087function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7088it is unlikely to be called.
7089@end defmac
7090
ae46c4e0
RH
7091@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7092Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7093and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7094As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7095the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7096
7097The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7098ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7099example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7100Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7101@end deftypefn
7102
d6b5193b
RS
7103@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7104Return the readonly data section associated with
ab5c8549 7105@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
d6b5193b
RS
7106The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7107the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7108if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7109otherwise.
ab5c8549
JJ
7110@end deftypefn
7111
727a65e6
BS
7112@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7113Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7114section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7115the string if a different section name should be used.
7116@end deftypevr
7117
50b0b78a
IS
7118@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7119Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7120@end deftypefn
7121
d6b5193b
RS
7122@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7123Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7124should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
b64a1b53 7125constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
d6b5193b
RS
7126case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7127in bits.
b64a1b53
RH
7128
7129The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7130constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7131else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7132@end deftypefn
7133
914d25dc 7134@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
5234b8f5
DS
7135Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7136by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7137the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7138or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7139hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7140your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7141returns the @var{id} provided.
7142@end deftypefn
7143
c6a2438a 7144@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
fb49053f
RH
7145Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7146treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7147function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7148
c6a2438a
ZW
7149The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7150@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7151an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7152rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
0864034e 7153in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
c6a2438a
ZW
7154
7155In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7156a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7157will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7158register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7159rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7160leave it alone.)
fb49053f
RH
7161
7162The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
c6a2438a 7163that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
fb49053f
RH
7164be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7165declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7166declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
c6a2438a 7167@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
fb49053f
RH
7168
7169@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
c6a2438a
ZW
7170The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7171@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7172Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7173encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7174discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7175
7176The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7177in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7178@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7179before overriding it.
fb49053f
RH
7180@end deftypefn
7181
914d25dc 7182@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
772c5265
RH
7183Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7184the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7185may have added.
7186@end deftypefn
7187
b6fd8800 7188@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7189Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7190The default version of this hook always returns false.
7191@end deftypefn
7192
9e3be889 7193@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
e2a6476e
DE
7194Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7195``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
9e3be889 7196@end deftypevr
e2a6476e 7197
3c5273a9
KT
7198@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7199It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7200
7201The default version of this hook use the target macro
7202@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7203@end deftypefn
7204
b6fd8800 7205@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7206Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7207rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7208or executable image).
7209
7210The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7211for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7212currently supported object file formats.
7213@end deftypefn
7214
9e3be889 7215@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
e2a6476e
DE
7216Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7217The default value is false.
9e3be889 7218@end deftypevr
e2a6476e
DE
7219
7220
feca2ed3
JW
7221@node PIC
7222@section Position Independent Code
7223@cindex position independent code
7224@cindex PIC
7225
7226This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7227independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
c6c3dba9
PB
7228generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7229@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7230@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7231must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7232when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7233need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7234relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7235@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
feca2ed3
JW
7236@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7237
a2c4f8e0 7238@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
7239The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7240data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
161d7b59 7241processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
feca2ed3
JW
7242is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7243pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7244is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
003b9f78 7245necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
12beba6f 7246when @code{flag_pic} is true).
a2c4f8e0 7247@end defmac
feca2ed3 7248
a2c4f8e0 7249@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7250A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7251@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7252the default is zero. Do not define
ed4db1ee 7253this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
a2c4f8e0 7254@end defmac
feca2ed3 7255
a2c4f8e0 7256@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
7257A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7258operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7259You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7260check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7261check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7262(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7263position independent code.
a2c4f8e0 7264@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7265
7266@node Assembler Format
7267@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7268
7269This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
648c546a 7270to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
feca2ed3
JW
7271instructions do.
7272
7273@menu
7274* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7275* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7276* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7277* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7278* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6ccde948 7279 and termination routines.
feca2ed3 7280* Macros for Initialization::
6ccde948
RW
7281 Specific macros that control the handling of
7282 initialization and termination routines.
feca2ed3
JW
7283* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7284* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7285* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7286* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7287@end menu
7288
7289@node File Framework
7290@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7291@cindex assembler format
7292@cindex output of assembler code
7293
7294@c prevent bad page break with this line
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7295This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7296
1bc7c5b6 7297@findex default_file_start
914d25dc 7298@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7299Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7300find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7301by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7302quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7303@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7304lets other target files rely on these variables.
7305@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7306
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7307@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7308If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7309printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7310@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7311to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7312definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7313assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7314whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7315
7316The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7317verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7318comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7319@end deftypevr
7320
7321@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7322If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7323for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7324@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7325this to be done. The default is false.
7326@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 7327
b6fd8800 7328@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
a5fe455b
ZW
7329Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7330to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7331@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7332
a5fe455b
ZW
7333@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7334Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7335special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7336the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7337should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7338need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7339this function.
7340@end deftypefun
feca2ed3 7341
c082f9f3
SB
7342@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7343Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7344to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7345nothing.
7346@end deftypefn
7347
7348@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7349Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7350to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7351nothing.
7352@end deftypefn
7353
6d217c32
JJ
7354@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7355Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7356unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7357here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7358because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7359nothing.
7360@end deftypefn
7361
a2c4f8e0 7362@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
feca2ed3
JW
7363A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7364assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7365the end of the line.
a2c4f8e0 7366@end defmac
feca2ed3 7367
a2c4f8e0 7368@defmac ASM_APP_ON
feca2ed3
JW
7369A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7370statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7371@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7372assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7373that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
a2c4f8e0 7374@end defmac
feca2ed3 7375
a2c4f8e0 7376@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
feca2ed3
JW
7377A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7378statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7379@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7380time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
a2c4f8e0 7381@end defmac
feca2ed3 7382
a2c4f8e0 7383@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7384A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7385which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7386the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7387
7388This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7389for the file format in use is appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 7390@end defmac
feca2ed3 7391
b5f5d41d
AS
7392@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7393Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
edeab219 7394
b5f5d41d
AS
7395 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7396@end deftypefn
7397
a8781821
SB
7398@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7399Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7400@end deftypefn
7401
a2c4f8e0 7402@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
e9a25f70
JL
7403A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7404@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
a3a15b4d 7405in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
e9a25f70
JL
7406the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7407of the filename using this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7408@end defmac
e9a25f70 7409
914d25dc 7410@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7c262518
RH
7411Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7412should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
914d25dc
JR
7413of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7414is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7415this section is associated.
7c262518
RH
7416@end deftypefn
7417
f16d3f39
JH
7418@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7419Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7420Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7421functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7422at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7423@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7424(from static destructors).
7425Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7426@end deftypefn
7427
14d11d40
IS
7428@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7429Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7430@end deftypefn
7431
677f3fa8 7432@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7c262518 7433This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7434It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
914d25dc 7435@end deftypevr
7c262518 7436
434aeebb 7437@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
914d25dc 7438@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
434aeebb
RS
7439This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7440section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7441This is true on most ELF targets.
914d25dc 7442@end deftypevr
434aeebb 7443
7c262518
RH
7444@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7445Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7446based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7447declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6ccde948 7448null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7c262518 7449
224504d2 7450The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7c262518
RH
7451read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7452need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7453set via @code{__attribute__}.
7454@end deftypefn
7455
b6fd8800 7456@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
e0d9d0dd
NC
7457Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7458switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7459enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7460It can take the following values:
7461
7462@table @gcctabopt
7463@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7464@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7465
7466@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7467@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7468direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7469default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7470command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7471various different individual optimization passes.
7472
7473@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7474@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7475ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7476target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7477time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7478warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7479wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7480necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7481perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7482switches.
7483
7484@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7485This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7486
7487@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7488This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7489@end table
7490
7491The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7492supported in the future.
7493
7494By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7495provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7496it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7497section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7498provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7499hook.
7500@end deftypefn
7501
914d25dc 7502@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
e0d9d0dd
NC
7503This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7504ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7505hook.
914d25dc 7506@end deftypevr
e0d9d0dd 7507
feca2ed3
JW
7508@need 2000
7509@node Data Output
7510@subsection Output of Data
7511
301d03af
RS
7512
7513@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7514@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7515@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7516@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7517@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7518@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7519@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7520@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7521@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7522These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7523of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7524byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7525aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7526@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7527
7528The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7529followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7530the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7531@end deftypevr
7532
7533@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7534The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7535integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7536in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7537function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7538object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7539split the object into smaller parts.
7540
7541The default implementation of this hook will use the
7542@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7543when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7544@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7545
6cbd8875
AS
7546@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7547A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7548can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7549the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7550@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7551
7552If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7553so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7554itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7555return @code{true}.
7556@end deftypefn
7557
a2c4f8e0 7558@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
feca2ed3
JW
7559A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7560instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7561bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7562@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7563
7564If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7565Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7566@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
a2c4f8e0 7567@end defmac
feca2ed3 7568
a2c4f8e0 7569@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
67231816
RH
7570A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7571@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7572is defined, and is otherwise unused.
a2c4f8e0 7573@end defmac
67231816 7574
a2c4f8e0 7575@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
861bb6c1 7576You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
df2a54e9 7577expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
861bb6c1 7578pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
a3a15b4d
JL
7579GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7580not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
861bb6c1 7581pool before the function.
a2c4f8e0 7582@end defmac
861bb6c1 7583
a2c4f8e0 7584@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
feca2ed3
JW
7585A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7586constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7587the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7588be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7589is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7590immediately after this call.
7591
7592If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7593not be defined.
a2c4f8e0 7594@end defmac
feca2ed3 7595
a2c4f8e0 7596@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
feca2ed3
JW
7597A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7598constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7599anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7600
7601The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7602assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7603output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7604@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7605@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7606alignment.
7607
7608The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7609the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7610responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7611Here is how to do this:
7612
3ab51846 7613@smallexample
4977bab6 7614@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
3ab51846 7615@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
7616
7617When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7618@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7619entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7620
7621You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7622@end defmac
feca2ed3 7623
a2c4f8e0 7624@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
861bb6c1
JL
7625A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7626pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7627function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7628obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
a3a15b4d 7629constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
861bb6c1
JL
7630
7631If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7632define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7633@end defmac
861bb6c1 7634
980d8882 7635@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
feca2ed3 7636Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
980d8882
BS
7637used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7638to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7639a line separator uses multiple characters.
feca2ed3
JW
7640
7641If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7642the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
a2c4f8e0 7643@end defmac
feca2ed3 7644
8ca83838 7645@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
baed53ac 7646@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
17b53c33
NB
7647These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7648assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7649default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8ca83838 7650@end deftypevr
17b53c33 7651
6ccde948 7652These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
feca2ed3
JW
7653of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7654
a2c4f8e0
ZW
7655@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7656@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7657@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
dadb213f
BE
7658@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7659@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7660@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7661These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7662target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7663the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7664@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7665simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7666@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7667by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7668it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
766932 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7670on the host machine.
feca2ed3
JW
7671
7672The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7673using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7674machine's memory.
a2c4f8e0 7675@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7676
7677@node Uninitialized Data
7678@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7679
7680Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7681outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7682
a2c4f8e0 7683@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7684A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7685@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7686@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
233215fe
DK
7687is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7688possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7689other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7690backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7691byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7692equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7693the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7694an ordinary undefined external.
feca2ed3
JW
7695
7696Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7697output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7698assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7699
7700This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7701common global variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7702@end defmac
feca2ed3 7703
a2c4f8e0 7704@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7705Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7706separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7707place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7708handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7709as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7710@end defmac
feca2ed3 7711
a2c4f8e0 7712@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7713Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7714variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7715is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7716in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7717@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7718the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7719@end defmac
e9a25f70 7720
07c5f94e 7721@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7722A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7723@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7724@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7725is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
feca2ed3 7726
07c5f94e
AS
7727Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7728@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
feca2ed3
JW
7729@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7730before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7731the name, and a newline.
7732
07c5f94e 7733There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
434aeebb
RS
7734The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7735switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7736You do not need to do both.
7737
7738Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7739non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7740efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7741not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7742common in order to save space in the object file.
a2c4f8e0 7743@end defmac
feca2ed3 7744
a2c4f8e0 7745@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7746A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7747@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7748@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7749is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7750
7751Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7752output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7753assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7754
7755This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7756static variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7757@end defmac
feca2ed3 7758
a2c4f8e0 7759@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7760Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7761separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7762place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7763handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7764as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7765@end defmac
feca2ed3 7766
a2c4f8e0 7767@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7768Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7769variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7770is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7771in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7772@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7773the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7774@end defmac
e9a25f70 7775
feca2ed3
JW
7776@node Label Output
7777@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7778
7779@c prevent bad page break with this line
7780This is about outputting labels.
7781
feca2ed3 7782@findex assemble_name
a2c4f8e0 7783@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7784A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7785@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7786Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7787output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
4ad5e05d
KG
7788assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7789definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 7790@end defmac
feca2ed3 7791
135a687e
KT
7792@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7793A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7794@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7795a function.
7796Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7797output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7798assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7799definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7800
7801If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7802usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7803@end defmac
7804
57829bc4
MM
7805@findex assemble_name_raw
7806@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
e374d5c9 7807Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
57829bc4
MM
7808to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7809@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7810that it is more efficient.
7811@end defmac
7812
a2c4f8e0 7813@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7814A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7815size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7816default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7817systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7818
7819Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7820of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7821for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7822macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7823define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7824@end defmac
2be2ac70 7825
a2c4f8e0 7826@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
2be2ac70
ZW
7827A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7828@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7829symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7830If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7831provided.
a2c4f8e0 7832@end defmac
2be2ac70 7833
a2c4f8e0 7834@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
2be2ac70
ZW
7835A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
99086d59 7837the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
73774972 7838address.
99086d59
ZW
7839
7840If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7841provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7842@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7843the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7844not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7845to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
a2c4f8e0 7846@end defmac
2be2ac70 7847
e537ef59
GP
7848@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7849Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7850@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7851G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7852@samp{.} is used instead.
7853@end defmac
7854
7855@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7856Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7857@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7858have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7859are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7860@end defmac
7861
a2c4f8e0 7862@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7863A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7864type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7865default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7866systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7867
7868Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7869@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7870custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7871types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7872@end defmac
2be2ac70 7873
a2c4f8e0 7874@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
2be2ac70
ZW
7875A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7876the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7877default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7878the default is not to define this macro.
7879
7880Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7881@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7882custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7883types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7884@end defmac
2be2ac70 7885
a2c4f8e0 7886@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
2be2ac70
ZW
7887A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7888@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7889symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7890that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7891you should not count on this.
7892
7893If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7894definition of this macro is provided.
a2c4f8e0 7895@end defmac
2be2ac70 7896
a2c4f8e0 7897@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7898A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7899@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7900function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7901outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7902@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
feca2ed3
JW
7903@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7904
7905If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7906usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
feca2ed3 7907
2be2ac70
ZW
7908You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7909of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7910@end defmac
2be2ac70 7911
a2c4f8e0 7912@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7913A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7914@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7915which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7916function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7917representing the function.
7918
7919If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7920
2be2ac70
ZW
7921You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7922of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7923@end defmac
2be2ac70 7924
a2c4f8e0 7925@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7926A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7928initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7929label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7930@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7931
7932If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7933usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7934
2be2ac70
ZW
7935You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7936@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7937@end defmac
2be2ac70 7938
ad78130c 7939@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
e4f7c483
AS
7940A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7941for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7942target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7943@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7944and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7945will be an internal label.
18f3e349 7946
e4f7c483
AS
7947The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7948usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
18f3e349 7949
e4f7c483
AS
7950You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7951@end deftypefn
18f3e349 7952
a2c4f8e0 7953@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
1cb36a98
RH
7954A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7955@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7956for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7957
7958If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7959nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7960@end defmac
1cb36a98 7961
a2c4f8e0 7962@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
feca2ed3
JW
7963A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7964once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7965chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7966initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7967something about the size of the object.
7968
7969If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7970nothing.
7971
2be2ac70
ZW
7972You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7973@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7974@end defmac
2be2ac70 7975
5eb99654
KG
7976@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7977This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
feca2ed3 7978@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
5eb99654 7979that is, available for reference from other files.
feca2ed3 7980
5eb99654
KG
7981The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7982@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
b65d23aa 7983@end deftypefn
072cdaed 7984
812b587e
SE
7985@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7986This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7987@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7988global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7989
7990The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7991@end deftypefn
7992
a2c4f8e0 7993@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7994A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7995@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7996that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7997no other definition is available. Use the expression
7998@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7999itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8000for making that name weak, and a newline.
8001
79c4e63f
AM
8002If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8003support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8004macro.
a2c4f8e0 8005@end defmac
79c4e63f 8006
a2c4f8e0 8007@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
79c4e63f
AM
8008Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8009@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8010or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8011should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8012defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8013@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8014to make @var{name} weak.
a2c4f8e0 8015@end defmac
feca2ed3 8016
ff2d10c1
AO
8017@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8018Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8019symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8020declaration of @code{name}.
8021@end defmac
8022
a2c4f8e0 8023@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
8024A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8025supports weak symbols.
feca2ed3
JW
8026
8027If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
79c4e63f 8028definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
8029is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8030@end defmac
8031
8032@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8033A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8034
8035If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8036definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8037this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8038flag such as @option{-melf}.
a2c4f8e0 8039@end defmac
feca2ed3 8040
a2c4f8e0 8041@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
8042A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8043public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8044be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8045format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8046section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8047requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
a2c4f8e0 8048@end defmac
feca2ed3 8049
a2c4f8e0 8050@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
feca2ed3
JW
8051A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8052semantics.
8053
8054If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8055definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8056definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
e9a25f70 8057you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
feca2ed3
JW
8058setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8059be emitted as one-only.
a2c4f8e0 8060@end defmac
feca2ed3 8061
914d25dc 8062@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
93638d7a
AM
8063This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8064commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8065hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8066@end deftypefn
8067
0524c91d 8068@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
4746cf84 8069A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
0524c91d 8070that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
f676971a 8071The default is @code{0}.
0524c91d
MA
8072
8073Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8074if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8075will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8076symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8077thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8078(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8079with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8080
8081The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8082targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8083restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8084table of contents.
4746cf84
MA
8085@end defmac
8086
a2c4f8e0 8087@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8088A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8089@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8090symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8091not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8092declaration.
8093
8094This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8095The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
a2c4f8e0 8096@end defmac
feca2ed3 8097
6773a41c
RO
8098@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8099This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
feca2ed3 8100pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6773a41c
RO
8101library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8102@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8103
914d25dc 8104@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8e3e233b 8105This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
914d25dc
JR
8106directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8107.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8e3e233b
DP
8108@end deftypefn
8109
a2c4f8e0 8110@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8111A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8112@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8113@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8114is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8115systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
a2c4f8e0 8116@end defmac
feca2ed3 8117
77754180
DK
8118@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8119Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8120@end deftypefn
8121
a2c4f8e0 8122@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
99c8c61c 8123A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
2f0b7af6 8124@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
99c8c61c
AO
8125will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8126to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
fb49053f 8127encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 8128@end defmac
99c8c61c 8129
a2c4f8e0 8130@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
2f0b7af6 8131A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
4226378a 8132result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
2f0b7af6
GK
8133@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8134This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8135specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
4226378a
PK
8136when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8137being taken.
a2c4f8e0 8138@end defmac
2f0b7af6 8139
4977bab6
ZW
8140@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8141A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8142name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
feca2ed3
JW
8143
8144It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8145used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8146will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8147
8148It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8149object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8150should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8151beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8152convention your system uses, and follow it.
8153
8a36672b 8154The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
4977bab6 8155@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8156
a2c4f8e0 8157@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8215347e
JW
8158A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8159label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8160@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8161may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8162systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8163bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8164bundles.
8165
4977bab6 8166If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8215347e 8167used.
a2c4f8e0 8168@end defmac
8215347e 8169
a2c4f8e0 8170@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
8171A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8172is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8173
8174This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
4977bab6 8175produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
feca2ed3
JW
8176with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8177
8178If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8179output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8180@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8181string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8182to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8183@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8184you should know what it does on your machine.)
a2c4f8e0 8185@end defmac
feca2ed3 8186
a2c4f8e0 8187@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
feca2ed3
JW
8188A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8189@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8190@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8191added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8192
8193The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8194produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8195@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8196assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8197macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8198internal static variables in different scopes.
8199
8200Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8201conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8202or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8203between the name and the number will suffice.
8204
4977bab6
ZW
8205If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8206which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8207@end defmac
4977bab6 8208
a2c4f8e0 8209@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8210A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8211which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8212
203cb4ef 8213@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8214If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
feca2ed3 8215correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8216@end defmac
810e3c45 8217
a2c4f8e0 8218@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
e4faf1eb 8219A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
3b7a2e58 8220which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
e4faf1eb
NC
8221to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8222be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8223the tree nodes are available.
8224
203cb4ef 8225@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8226If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
956d6950 8227correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8228@end defmac
956d6950 8229
083b6717
JDA
8230@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8231A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8232(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8233of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8234current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8235This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8236@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8237@end defmac
8238
a2c4f8e0 8239@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
810e3c45
JM
8240A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8241which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3aa8ab7b
L
8242@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8243an undefined weak symbol.
810e3c45
JM
8244
8245Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
aee96fe9 8246@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
a2c4f8e0 8247@end defmac
810e3c45 8248
a2c4f8e0 8249@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
feca2ed3 8250Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
2147b154 8251Objective-C methods.
feca2ed3
JW
8252
8253The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8254class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8255the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8256@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8257
8258These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8259the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8260systems define other ways of computing names.
8261
8262@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8263buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8264@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
826550 characters extra.
8266
8267The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8268method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
59d42021 8269@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
feca2ed3
JW
8270in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8271
8272On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8273macro to provide more human-readable names.
a2c4f8e0 8274@end defmac
28df0b5a 8275
feca2ed3
JW
8276@node Initialization
8277@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8278@cindex initialization routines
8279@cindex termination routines
8280@cindex constructors, output of
8281@cindex destructors, output of
8282
8283The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8284(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8285data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8286to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8287@code{main} is called.
8288
8289Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8290@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8291terminates.
8292
8293To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8294must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8295be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8296system, you need to specify how to do this.
8297
8298There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8299initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8300Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8301
8302@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8303@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8304The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8305initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8306termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8307
8308Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
83090, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8310the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8311pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8312pointer containing zero.
8313
8314Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8315@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8316time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8317list; destructors in forward order.
8318
8319The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8320formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8321aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8322Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8323object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8324the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8325accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8326Termination functions are handled similarly.
8327
2cc07db4
RH
8328This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8329@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
f282ffb3 8330support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
2cc07db4
RH
8331constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8332and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
feca2ed3
JW
8333
8334When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8335upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
2cc07db4 8336support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
feca2ed3 8337parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
05739753 8338program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
feca2ed3 8339
3ab51846 8340@smallexample
2cc07db4 8341ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
3ab51846 8342@end smallexample
feca2ed3 8343
2cc07db4
RH
8344The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8345section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8346for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8347files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8348are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8349
8350The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8351compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8352fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8353to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8354of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8355that invokes the routines we need at startup.
feca2ed3
JW
8356
8357To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8358macro properly.
8359
2cc07db4
RH
8360If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8361@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8362entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8363it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8364after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8365in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
feca2ed3
JW
8366
8367In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8368two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8369and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
2cc07db4 8370@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
feca2ed3
JW
8371entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8372and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8373code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
2cc07db4 8374the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
feca2ed3
JW
8375placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8376a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
2cc07db4 8377@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
feca2ed3
JW
8378section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8379the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8380the initialization process.
8381
8382The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8383This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
161d7b59 8384file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
2cc07db4
RH
8385this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8386termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8387an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8388pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8389the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8390initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8391via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8392@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
feca2ed3
JW
8393
8394@ifinfo
8395The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8396customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8397@end ifinfo
8398
8399@node Macros for Initialization
8400@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8401
8402Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8403and termination functions:
8404
a2c4f8e0 8405@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
8406If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8407operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8408defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8409using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8410macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8411run the initialization functions.
a2c4f8e0 8412@end defmac
feca2ed3 8413
a2c4f8e0 8414@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
feca2ed3 8415If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
2cc07db4
RH
8416This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8417on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8418be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
a2c4f8e0 8419@end defmac
feca2ed3 8420
a2c4f8e0 8421@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8422If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8423the following symbol is an initialization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8424@end defmac
feca2ed3 8425
a2c4f8e0 8426@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8427If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8428the following symbol is a finalization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8429@end defmac
feca2ed3 8430
a2c4f8e0 8431@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8432If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8433automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8434should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8435the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
172270b3 8436function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
414e05cf
RE
8437
8438This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
f282ffb3 8439shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
414e05cf 8440exception tables embedded in the code.
a2c4f8e0 8441@end defmac
414e05cf 8442
a2c4f8e0 8443@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8444If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8445automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8446should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8447the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
172270b3 8448function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
a2c4f8e0 8449@end defmac
414e05cf 8450
a2c4f8e0 8451@defmac INVOKE__main
feca2ed3
JW
8452If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8453@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8454where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8455useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
a2c4f8e0 8456@end defmac
feca2ed3 8457
a2c4f8e0 8458@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
ea4f1fce
JO
8459If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8460compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8461of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8462encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
a2c4f8e0 8463@end defmac
2cc07db4 8464
914d25dc 8465@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
2cc07db4
RH
8466This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8467collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8468It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
914d25dc 8469@end deftypevr
2cc07db4
RH
8470
8471@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8472If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8473the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
ea4f1fce 8474
2cc07db4
RH
8475Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8476no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8477priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8478otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8479
14976c58 8480If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
2cc07db4
RH
8481be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8482target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8483is not defined.
8484@end deftypefn
8485
8486@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8487This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
feca2ed3 8488functions rather than initialization functions.
2cc07db4 8489@end deftypefn
14686fcd 8490
2cc07db4
RH
8491If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8492generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
feca2ed3 8493
2cc07db4
RH
8494If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8495constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8496an object file for constructor functions to be called.
14686fcd 8497
4a023207 8498On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
2cc07db4 8499@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
feca2ed3 8500
a2c4f8e0 8501@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
feca2ed3 8502Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
2cc07db4 8503object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
feca2ed3 8504object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
feca2ed3 8505
4a023207 8506This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
2cc07db4 8507part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
a2c4f8e0 8508@end defmac
feca2ed3 8509
a2c4f8e0 8510@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
feca2ed3 8511Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
2cc07db4
RH
8512to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8513@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8514@end defmac
8515
8516@defmac NM_FLAGS
8517@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8518constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8519passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8520are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8521produces.
8522@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8523
8524If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8525dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8526these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8527termination functions in shared libraries:
8528
a2c4f8e0 8529@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
2cc07db4 8530Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8531which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
a2c4f8e0 8532@end defmac
feca2ed3 8533
a2c4f8e0 8534@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
feca2ed3 8535Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
aee96fe9 8536of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
feca2ed3
JW
8537of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8538from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
aee96fe9
JM
8539code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8540line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
a2c4f8e0 8541@end defmac
feca2ed3 8542
881466d8
JDA
8543@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8544Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8545library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8546strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8547constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8548that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8549@end defmac
8550
feca2ed3
JW
8551@node Instruction Output
8552@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8553
8554@c prevent bad page break with this line
8555This describes assembler instruction output.
8556
a2c4f8e0 8557@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8558A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8559registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8560register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
a2c4f8e0 8561@end defmac
feca2ed3 8562
a2c4f8e0 8563@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8564If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8565and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8566registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8567to registers using alternate names.
a2c4f8e0 8568@end defmac
feca2ed3 8569
0c6d290e
RE
8570@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8571If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8572name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8573machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8574names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8575declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8576@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8577register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8578
8579This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8580@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8581register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8582VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8583``s0'' and ``s1''.
8584@end defmac
8585
a2c4f8e0 8586@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
feca2ed3
JW
8587Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8588requires different names for the machine instructions.
8589
8590The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8591assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8592macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8593points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8594written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8595opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8596increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8597so that it will not be output twice.
8598
8599In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8600name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8601that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8602care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8603@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8604
37bef197 8605@findex recog_data.operand
feca2ed3 8606If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
37bef197 8607elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
feca2ed3
JW
8608
8609If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8610in the usual way.
a2c4f8e0 8611@end defmac
feca2ed3 8612
a2c4f8e0 8613@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
feca2ed3
JW
8614If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8615assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8616they will be output differently.
8617
8618Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8619extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8620elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8621The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8622template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8623by changing the contents of the vector.
8624
8625This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8626file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8627can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8628as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8629syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8630writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8631
8632If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
a2c4f8e0 8633@end defmac
feca2ed3 8634
914d25dc 8635@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
1afc5373
CF
8636If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8637output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8638if necessary.
8639
8640Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8641extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8642elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8643The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8644template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8645by checking the contents of the vector.
8646@end deftypefn
8647
a2c4f8e0 8648@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8649A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8650assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8651RTL expression.
8652
8653@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8654of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8655printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8656the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8657operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8658@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8659@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8660
8661@findex reg_names
8662If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8663The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8664@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8665@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8666
8667When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8668(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8669with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8670@var{code}.
a2c4f8e0 8671@end defmac
feca2ed3 8672
a2c4f8e0 8673@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8674A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8675punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8676@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8677punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8678in this way.
a2c4f8e0 8679@end defmac
feca2ed3 8680
a2c4f8e0 8681@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
8682A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8683assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8684whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8685
fb49053f 8686@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
feca2ed3 8687On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
fb49053f
RH
8688section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8689@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8690@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8691Format}.
8692@end defmac
feca2ed3 8693
feca2ed3 8694@findex dbr_sequence_length
a2c4f8e0 8695@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
feca2ed3
JW
8696A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8697been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8698determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8699currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8700or whatever.
8701
8702Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8703reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
e979f9e8 8704explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
a2c4f8e0 8705@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8706
8707@findex final_sequence
8708Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
e979f9e8
JM
8709prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8710(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
feca2ed3
JW
8711found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8712processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8713being output.
8714
feca2ed3 8715@findex asm_fprintf
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8716@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8717@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8718@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8719@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
8720If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8721@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8722@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8723support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8724files can define these macros differently.
a2c4f8e0 8725@end defmac
feca2ed3 8726
a2c4f8e0 8727@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
3b7a2e58 8728If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
fe0503ea
NC
8729statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8730the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8731printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
4bd0bee9 8732statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
fe0503ea
NC
8733generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8734specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8735The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8736string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8737upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
a2c4f8e0 8738@end defmac
fe0503ea 8739
a2c4f8e0 8740@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
feca2ed3
JW
8741If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8742different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8743numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8744first variant.
8745
8746If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
c237e94a 8747@smallexample
f282ffb3 8748@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
c237e94a
ZW
8749@end smallexample
8750@noindent
8751in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8752first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8753@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8754@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8755within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8756alternatives within the braces than the value of
8757@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
feca2ed3
JW
8758
8759If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8760@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8761operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8762
8763Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8764@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
e5e809f4 8765the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
feca2ed3
JW
8766@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8767if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8768opcodes or operand order.
a2c4f8e0 8769@end defmac
feca2ed3 8770
a2c4f8e0 8771@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8772A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8773which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8774The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8775profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8776@end defmac
feca2ed3 8777
a2c4f8e0 8778@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8779A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8780which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8781The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8782profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8783@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8784
8785@node Dispatch Tables
8786@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8787
8788@c prevent bad page break with this line
8789This concerns dispatch tables.
8790
feca2ed3 8791@cindex dispatch table
a2c4f8e0 8792@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
feca2ed3
JW
8793A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8794pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8795@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8796definitions of these labels are output using
4977bab6 8797@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
feca2ed3
JW
8798way here. For example,
8799
3ab51846 8800@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8801fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8802 @var{value}, @var{rel})
3ab51846 8803@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8804
8805You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
f0523f02 8806dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
161d7b59 8807will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
aee96fe9 8808@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
33f7f353 8809mode and flags can be read.
a2c4f8e0 8810@end defmac
feca2ed3 8811
a2c4f8e0 8812@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8813This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8814in a dispatch table are absolute.
8815
8816The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8817@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8818a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
4977bab6 8819definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
feca2ed3
JW
8820For example,
8821
3ab51846 8822@smallexample
feca2ed3 8823fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
3ab51846 8824@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 8825@end defmac
feca2ed3 8826
a2c4f8e0 8827@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8828Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8829specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
4977bab6 8830@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
feca2ed3
JW
8831jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8832@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8833
8834This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8835for the table.
8836
8837If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
4977bab6 8838@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
a2c4f8e0 8839@end defmac
feca2ed3 8840
a2c4f8e0 8841@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8842Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8843jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8844after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8845the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8846@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8847of the preceding label.
8848
8849If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8850the jump-table.
a2c4f8e0 8851@end defmac
feca2ed3 8852
914d25dc 8853@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8a36672b 8854This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
4746cf84
MA
8855should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8856should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8857function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
eeab4d81
MS
8858The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8859exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8a36672b 8860true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
4746cf84
MA
8861
8862The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8863@end deftypefn
8864
914d25dc 8865@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
083cad55
EC
8866This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8867It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8868to be broken up according to function.
8869
8870The default is that no label is emitted.
8871@end deftypefn
8872
a68b5e52
RH
8873@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8874If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8875@end deftypefn
8876
38f8b050 8877@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
914d25dc 8878This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8879given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8880returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
951120ea
PB
8881@end deftypefn
8882
3bc6b3e6
RH
8883@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8884True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8885@end deftypevr
8886
02f52e19 8887@node Exception Region Output
feca2ed3
JW
8888@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8889
8890@c prevent bad page break with this line
8891
8892This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8893region.
8894
a2c4f8e0 8895@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7c262518
RH
8896If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8897exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8898provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8899@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
0021b564
JM
8900
8901You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8902unwind information and the default definition does not work.
a2c4f8e0 8903@end defmac
0021b564 8904
a2c4f8e0 8905@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
02c9b1ca
RH
8906If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8907data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8908might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8909collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8910
8911Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8912also defined.
a2c4f8e0 8913@end defmac
02c9b1ca 8914
1a35e62d
MM
8915@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8916Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8917information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8918runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8919and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8920@end defmac
8921
a2c4f8e0 8922@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
aee96fe9 8923An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
feca2ed3 8924that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
a2c4f8e0 8925@end defmac
0021b564 8926
a2c4f8e0 8927@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
0021b564
JM
8928Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8929information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8930Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
8931@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8932GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 8933@end defmac
0021b564 8934
677f3fa8 8935@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
f0a0390e
RH
8936This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8937by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8938should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8939@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8940should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8941information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
0021b564 8942
f0a0390e
RH
8943A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8944This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8945default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
0021b564 8946
f0a0390e 8947Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8948not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8949@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8950setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8951macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8952depending on this setting.
8953
8954The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8955@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8956@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8957@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8958must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8959@end deftypefn
951120ea 8960
677f3fa8 8961@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
617a1b71 8962This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8963tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8964command-line option processing.
9e3be889 8965@end deftypevr
617a1b71 8966
4f6c2131
EB
8967@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8968Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8969should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8970instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
c14aea87
RO
8971@end defmac
8972
39ce30d8
SB
8973@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8974This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8975defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8976for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8977is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8978The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8979@end defmac
8980
a2c4f8e0 8981@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
27c35f4b
HPN
8982This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8983function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8984@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8985alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8986minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8987the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
a2c4f8e0 8988@end defmac
feca2ed3 8989
9e3be889 8990@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7606e68f
SS
8991Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8992end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8993Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8994true otherwise.
9e3be889 8995@end deftypevr
7606e68f 8996
96714395
AH
8997@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8998Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8999represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9000register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9001locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9002register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9003If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9004@end deftypefn
9005
37ea0b7e
JM
9006@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9007If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9008multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9009sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9010It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9011filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9012@var{address} is the address of the table.
9013@end deftypefn
9014
617a1b71
PB
9015@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9016This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9017the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9018if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9019reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9020@end deftypefn
9021
914d25dc
JR
9022@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9023This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
617a1b71
PB
9024based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9025the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9026running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 9027@end deftypevr
617a1b71 9028
feca2ed3
JW
9029@node Alignment Output
9030@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9031
9032@c prevent bad page break with this line
9033This describes commands for alignment.
9034
a2c4f8e0 9035@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
247a370b 9036The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
f710504c 9037a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
25e22dc0
JH
9038
9039This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9040to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9041define the macro.
efa3896a 9042
3446405d
JH
9043Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9044to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
74f7912a 9045@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
247a370b 9046selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9047@end defmac
247a370b 9048
ad0c4c36
DD
9049@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9050The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9051@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9052@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9053@end deftypefn
9054
a2c4f8e0 9055@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
247a370b
JH
9056The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9057a @code{BARRIER}.
9058
9059This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9060to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9061define the macro.
a2c4f8e0 9062@end defmac
3446405d 9063
ad0c4c36
DD
9064@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9065The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
efa3896a
GK
9066@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9067@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 9068@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9069
a2c4f8e0 9070@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 9071The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
aee96fe9 9072a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
feca2ed3
JW
9073
9074This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9075to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9076define the macro.
9077
efa3896a 9078Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9079to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
74f7912a 9080@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9081selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9082@end defmac
efa3896a 9083
ad0c4c36
DD
9084@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9085The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9086@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9087defined.
9088@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9089
a2c4f8e0 9090@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 9091The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
aee96fe9 9092If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
fc470718
R
9093the maximum of the specified values is used.
9094
efa3896a 9095Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9096to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
74f7912a 9097@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9098selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9099@end defmac
efa3896a 9100
ad0c4c36
DD
9101@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9102The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9103to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9104is defined.
9105@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9106
a2c4f8e0 9107@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
feca2ed3
JW
9108A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9109instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9110Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
606e938d 9111expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
a2c4f8e0 9112@end defmac
feca2ed3 9113
a2c4f8e0 9114@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
feca2ed3 9115Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
556e0f21 9116text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
feca2ed3
JW
9117This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9118produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9119section.
a2c4f8e0 9120@end defmac
feca2ed3 9121
a2c4f8e0 9122@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
feca2ed3
JW
9123A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9124command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9125@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9126@end defmac
26f63a77 9127
a2c4f8e0 9128@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8e16ab99
SF
9129Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9130for padding, if necessary.
a2c4f8e0 9131@end defmac
8e16ab99 9132
a2c4f8e0 9133@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
26f63a77
JL
9134A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9135command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9136@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9137satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9138a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9139@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9140
9141@need 3000
9142@node Debugging Info
9143@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9144
9145@c prevent bad page break with this line
9146This describes how to specify debugging information.
9147
9148@menu
9149* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9150* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9151* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9152* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9153* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
5f98259a 9154* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
feca2ed3
JW
9155@end menu
9156
9157@node All Debuggers
9158@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9159
9160@c prevent bad page break with this line
9161These macros affect all debugging formats.
9162
a2c4f8e0 9163@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
feca2ed3 9164A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
4617e3b5
KG
9165register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9166of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9167some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9168versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9169compiler and another for DBX@.
feca2ed3 9170
a3a15b4d 9171If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
feca2ed3
JW
9172used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9173consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9174Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9175expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9176
9177If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9178does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9179redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
a2c4f8e0 9180@end defmac
feca2ed3 9181
a2c4f8e0 9182@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9183A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9184variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9185computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9186gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9187that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9188for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
630d3d5a 9189@option{-g} options is used.
a2c4f8e0 9190@end defmac
feca2ed3 9191
a2c4f8e0 9192@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9193A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9194having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9195@var{offset}.
a2c4f8e0 9196@end defmac
feca2ed3 9197
a2c4f8e0 9198@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
a3a15b4d 9199A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
630d3d5a 9200produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
a3a15b4d 9201this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
e5e809f4 9202debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
5f98259a
RK
9203@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9204@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
feca2ed3 9205
630d3d5a 9206When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
e5e809f4 9207value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
16201823 9208exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
e5e809f4 9209value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
a3a15b4d 9210defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
deabc777 9211
feca2ed3 9212The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
630d3d5a 9213user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
def66b10 9214@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
a2c4f8e0 9215@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9216
9217@node DBX Options
9218@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9219
9220@c prevent bad page break with this line
9221These are specific options for DBX output.
9222
a2c4f8e0 9223@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9224Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
630d3d5a 9225in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9226@end defmac
feca2ed3 9227
a2c4f8e0 9228@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9229Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
630d3d5a 9230in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
a2c4f8e0 9231@end defmac
feca2ed3 9232
a2c4f8e0 9233@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
a3a15b4d 9234Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
feca2ed3
JW
9235GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9236debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9237macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9238if there is any occasion to.
a2c4f8e0 9239@end defmac
feca2ed3 9240
a2c4f8e0 9241@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
feca2ed3
JW
9242Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9243in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 9244@end defmac
feca2ed3 9245
a2c4f8e0 9246@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9247A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9248use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9249If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9250applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9251@end defmac
feca2ed3 9252
a2c4f8e0 9253@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9254A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9255use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9256value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9257@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9258information format.
a2c4f8e0 9259@end defmac
feca2ed3 9260
a2c4f8e0 9261@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9262A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9263use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9264name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9265macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9266@end defmac
feca2ed3 9267
a2c4f8e0 9268@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
feca2ed3
JW
9269Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9270@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9271describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9272On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
a2c4f8e0 9273@end defmac
feca2ed3 9274
a2c4f8e0 9275@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
feca2ed3
JW
9276A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9277continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9278exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9279operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9280must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9281with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9282defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
a2c4f8e0 9283@end defmac
feca2ed3 9284
a2c4f8e0 9285@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
9286Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9287the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9288a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9289constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9290if backslash is correct for your system.
a2c4f8e0 9291@end defmac
feca2ed3 9292
a2c4f8e0 9293@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
feca2ed3
JW
9294Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9295outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9296variable.
a2c4f8e0 9297@end defmac
feca2ed3 9298
a2c4f8e0 9299@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9300The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9301for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9302@end defmac
feca2ed3 9303
a2c4f8e0 9304@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9305The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9306for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9307provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
a2c4f8e0 9308@end defmac
feca2ed3 9309
a2c4f8e0 9310@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9311The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9312for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9313``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9314@end defmac
feca2ed3 9315
a2c4f8e0 9316@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
feca2ed3
JW
9317The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9318passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9319do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
a2c4f8e0 9320@end defmac
feca2ed3 9321
a2c4f8e0 9322@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
feca2ed3
JW
9323Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9324arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9325in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9326code.
a2c4f8e0 9327@end defmac
feca2ed3 9328
a2c4f8e0 9329@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
3e487b21
ZW
9330Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9331the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9332relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9333an absolute address.
9334@end defmac
9335
9336@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9337Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9338the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9339start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
a2c4f8e0 9340@end defmac
feca2ed3 9341
a2c4f8e0 9342@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
f0523f02 9343Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
feca2ed3 9344@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
f0523f02
JM
9345macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9346number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
feca2ed3
JW
9347generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9348number for a type number.
a2c4f8e0 9349@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9350
9351@node DBX Hooks
9352@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9353
9354@c prevent bad page break with this line
9355These are hooks for DBX format.
9356
3e487b21
ZW
9357@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9358A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9359number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8a36672b 9360@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
3e487b21
ZW
9361invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9362unique labels in the assembly output.
9363
9364This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9365if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9366@end defmac
9367
a2c4f8e0 9368@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
feca2ed3 9369Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
c771326b 9370@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
feca2ed3
JW
9371On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9372disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
a2c4f8e0 9373@end defmac
feca2ed3 9374
5d865dac
EB
9375@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9376Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9377extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9378feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9379@end defmac
9380
feca2ed3
JW
9381@node File Names and DBX
9382@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9383
9384@c prevent bad page break with this line
9385This describes file names in DBX format.
9386
a2c4f8e0 9387@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9388A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
93a27b7b 9389@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
feca2ed3
JW
9390file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9391This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9392
9393This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9394for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
93a27b7b
ZW
9395
9396It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9397text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9398to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9399@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
a2c4f8e0 9400@end defmac
feca2ed3 9401
93a27b7b
ZW
9402@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9403Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9404of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9405the beginning of the file.
9406@end defmac
feca2ed3 9407
93a27b7b
ZW
9408@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9409Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9410that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9411an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9412@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
a2c4f8e0 9413@end defmac
feca2ed3 9414
a2c4f8e0 9415@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9416A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
93a27b7b
ZW
9417compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9418written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
feca2ed3
JW
9419
9420If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9421of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
a2c4f8e0 9422@end defmac
feca2ed3 9423
3e487b21
ZW
9424@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9425Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9426@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
e4ae5e77 9427the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
3e487b21
ZW
9428whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9429@end defmac
9430
feca2ed3
JW
9431@need 2000
9432@node SDB and DWARF
9433@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9434
9435@c prevent bad page break with this line
9436Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9437
a2c4f8e0 9438@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9439Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
630d3d5a 9440for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9441@end defmac
feca2ed3 9442
a2c4f8e0 9443@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9444Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
630d3d5a 9445debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
f3ff3f4a 9446
b6fd8800 9447@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
a1c496cb
EC
9448Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9449be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9450value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9451@end deftypefn
9452
861bb6c1
JL
9453To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9454define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9455@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9456prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
08c148a8 9457as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
a2c4f8e0 9458@end defmac
861bb6c1 9459
a2c4f8e0 9460@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
a3a15b4d 9461Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9462Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9463(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9464exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9465how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 9466@end defmac
9ec36da5 9467
f0a0390e
RH
9468@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9469This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9470unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9471@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9472return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9473
9474A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9475is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9476
9477A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9478This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9479@end deftypefn
9480
a2c4f8e0 9481@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
b2244e22
JW
9482Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9483line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9484tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
a2c4f8e0 9485@end defmac
b2244e22 9486
9730bc27
TT
9487@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9488True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9489@end deftypevr
9490
638c962f
JH
9491@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9492True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9493@end deftypevr
9494
2ba42841
AO
9495@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9496True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9497@end deftypevr
9498
9499@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9500True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9501@end deftypevr
9502
a2c4f8e0 9503@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7606e68f 9504A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
192d0f89 9505@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9506@end defmac
7606e68f 9507
67ad2ae7
DR
9508@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9509A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9510between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9511slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9512@end defmac
9513
192d0f89 9514@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7606e68f 9515A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
192d0f89
GK
9516section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9517given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
a2c4f8e0 9518@end defmac
7606e68f 9519
a2c4f8e0 9520@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7606e68f 9521A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
192d0f89 9522reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9523@end defmac
7606e68f 9524
7e49a4b3
OH
9525@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9526A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9527the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9528is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9529is referenced by a function.
9530@end defmac
9531
914d25dc 9532@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
fdbe66f2
EB
9533If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9534reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9535@end deftypefn
9536
a2c4f8e0 9537@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
feca2ed3
JW
9538Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9539SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9540macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9541not define them yourself.
a2c4f8e0 9542@end defmac
feca2ed3 9543
a2c4f8e0 9544@defmac SDB_DELIM
feca2ed3
JW
9545Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9546SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9547delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9548a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9549required.
a2c4f8e0 9550@end defmac
feca2ed3 9551
a2c4f8e0 9552@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9553Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9554union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9555allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9556it.
a2c4f8e0 9557@end defmac
feca2ed3 9558
a2c4f8e0 9559@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9560Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9561enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9562assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
a2c4f8e0 9563@end defmac
feca2ed3 9564
3e487b21
ZW
9565@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9566A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9567number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9568@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9569@end defmac
9570
5f98259a
RK
9571@need 2000
9572@node VMS Debug
9573@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9574
9575@c prevent bad page break with this line
9576Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9577
a2c4f8e0 9578@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5f98259a
RK
9579Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9580in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9581is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9582@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9583behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
74f7912a 9584@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
a2c4f8e0 9585@end defmac
5f98259a 9586
b216cd4a 9587@node Floating Point
feca2ed3
JW
9588@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9589@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9590@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9591
b216cd4a 9592While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
feca2ed3
JW
9593there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9594means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9595in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9596doing the compilation.
9597
feca2ed3 9598Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
b216cd4a
ZW
9599range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9600the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9601safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9602the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9603emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9604target floating point formats are identical.
9605
9606The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9607use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
ba31d94e
ZW
9608floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9609their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
feca2ed3 9610
b216cd4a
ZW
9611@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9612The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9613machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9614array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9615quantity.
9616@end defmac
9617
9618@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9619Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9620floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9621@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9622@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9623@end deftypefn
9624
9625@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9626Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9627@end deftypefn
9628
b216cd4a
ZW
9629@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9630Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9631@end deftypefn
9632
9633@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9634Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9635@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9636@end deftypefn
9637
b216cd4a
ZW
9638@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9639Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9640representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9641decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9642defined by the C language for both.
9643@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9644
15e5ad76 9645@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
ce3649d2 9646Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
15e5ad76
ZW
9647@end deftypefn
9648
b216cd4a
ZW
9649@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9650Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9651@end deftypefn
9652
9653@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9654Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9655@end deftypefn
9656
9657@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9658Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9659@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9660variable).
9661
9662The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9663following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9664@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9665
9666If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9667target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9668@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9669@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9670@end deftypefn
9671
9672@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9673Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9674@end deftypefn
9675
15e5ad76
ZW
9676@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9677Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9678@end deftypefn
9679
b216cd4a
ZW
9680@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9681Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9682which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9683integral, it is truncated.
9684@end deftypefn
9685
9686@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
b216cd4a
ZW
9687Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9688into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9689value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9690@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9691
9f09b1f2
R
9692@node Mode Switching
9693@section Mode Switching Instructions
9694@cindex mode switching
9695The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9696
a2c4f8e0 9697@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2
R
9698Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9699switching in an optimizing compilation.
9700
9701For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9702floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9703the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9704operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9705purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
e979f9e8 9706be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
18dbd950 9707or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9f09b1f2
R
9708
9709You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9710which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
14976c58 9711return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9f09b1f2
R
9712If you define this macro, you also have to define
9713@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9714@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
73774972
EC
9715@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9716are optional.
a2c4f8e0 9717@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9718
a2c4f8e0 9719@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9f09b1f2
R
9720If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9721initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9722N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9723of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
78466c0e
JM
9724The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9725zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9f09b1f2
R
9726entity in question.
9727In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
630d3d5a 9728represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9f09b1f2 9729switch is needed / supplied.
a2c4f8e0 9730@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9731
a2c4f8e0 9732@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9f09b1f2
R
9733@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9734@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9735return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
aee96fe9
JM
9736@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9737be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
a2c4f8e0 9738@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9739
9786913b
UB
9740@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9741@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9742this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
8a36672b 9743mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
73774972
EC
9744different from the incoming mode).
9745@end defmac
9746
9747@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9748If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8a36672b
JM
9749mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9750@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
73774972
EC
9751is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9752@end defmac
9753
9754@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2 9755If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8a36672b
JM
9756mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9757@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
73774972 9758is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
a2c4f8e0 9759@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9760
a2c4f8e0 9761@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
aee96fe9
JM
9762This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
97630 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9f09b1f2 9764lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
aee96fe9 9765for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
630d3d5a 9766(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
aee96fe9 9767@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
a2c4f8e0 9768@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9769
a2c4f8e0 9770@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9f09b1f2
R
9771Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9772@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9773the insn(s) are to be inserted.
a2c4f8e0 9774@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9775
91d231cb
JM
9776@node Target Attributes
9777@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9778@cindex target attributes
9779@cindex machine attributes
9780@cindex attributes, target-specific
9781
9782Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9783These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9784be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9785
9786@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9787If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9788attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9789specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9790entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9791take.
9792@end deftypevr
9793
564a129d
JM
9794@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9795If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9796machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9797given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9798subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9799false for all machine-specific attributes.
9800@end deftypefn
9801
b6fd8800 9802@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
91d231cb
JM
9803If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9804@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9805and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9806generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9807supposed always to be compatible.
9808@end deftypefn
9809
9810@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9811If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
914d25dc 9812the newly defined @var{type}.
91d231cb
JM
9813@end deftypefn
9814
9815@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9816Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9817handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9818@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9819that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9820function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9821merging.
9822@end deftypefn
9823
9824@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9825Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9826handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9827@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9828@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9829when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9830attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9831call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9832
9833@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
b2ca3702
MM
9834If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9835for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9836@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9837will then define a function called
9838@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9839the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9840add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9841to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9842@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9843@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
91d231cb
JM
9844@end deftypefn
9845
b6fd8800 9846@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9847@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
43d9ad1d
DS
9848@end deftypefn
9849
63c5b495 9850@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
1a141fe1 9851Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
63c5b495
MM
9852@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9853default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9854@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9855of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9856on this implementation detail.
9857@end defmac
9858
91d231cb
JM
9859@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9860Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9861when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9862wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9863the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9864created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9865for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9866shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9867the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9868attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9869needed.
9870@end deftypefn
9871
65a324b4 9872@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
91d231cb
JM
9873@cindex inlining
9874This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9875into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9876attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9877target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9878@end deftypefn
9879
914d25dc 9880@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
ab442df7
MM
9881This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9882it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9883options for the current function that might be different than the
9884options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9885@code{true} if the options are valid.
9886
9887The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9888the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9889@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9890@end deftypefn
9891
9892@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9893This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9894in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9895options.
9896@xref{Option file format}.
9897@end deftypefn
9898
9899@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9900This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9901information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9902function specific options.
9903@end deftypefn
9904
d2143a2f 9905@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
ab442df7
MM
9906This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9907information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9908function specific options.
9909@end deftypefn
9910
56cb42ea 9911@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
ab442df7
MM
9912This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9913set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9914input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9915@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
ab442df7
MM
9916@end deftypefn
9917
74f7912a
JR
9918@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9919Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9920a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9921@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9922once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9923
9924Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9925@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
74f7912a
JR
9926
9927If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9928changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9929@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9930@end deftypefn
9931
ab442df7
MM
9932@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9933This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9934cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9935default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9936specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9937@end deftypefn
9938
feb60f03
NS
9939@node Emulated TLS
9940@section Emulating TLS
9941@cindex Emulated TLS
9942
9943For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9944specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9945used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9946configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
a640c13b 9947the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
feb60f03
NS
9948layer.
9949
9950The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9951object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9952which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9953address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9954
9955@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9956Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9957object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9958emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9959@end deftypevr
9960
9961@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9962Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9963program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9964initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9965have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9966registration function to be used.
9967@end deftypevr
9968
9969@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9970Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9971be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9972any section.
9973@end deftypevr
9974
9975@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9976Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9977placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9978section.
9979@end deftypevr
9980
9981@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9982Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9983The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9984@end deftypevr
9985
9986@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9987Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9988default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9989@end deftypevr
9990
9991@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9992Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9993object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9994@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9995@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9996for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9997@end deftypefn
9998
9999@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10000Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10001TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10002is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10003initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10004@end deftypefn
10005
b6fd8800 10006@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
feb60f03
NS
10007Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10008fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10009single objects. The default is false.
10010@end deftypevr
10011
b6fd8800 10012@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
feb60f03
NS
10013Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10014may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10015@end deftypevr
10016
d604bca3
MH
10017@node MIPS Coprocessors
10018@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10019@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10020
10021The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
2dd76960 10022coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
d604bca3
MH
10023accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10024and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10025
10026@smallexample
10027 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10028 unsigned int d;
10029
10030 d = cp0count + 3;
10031@end smallexample
10032
10033(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10034names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10035overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10036
10037Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10038be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10039later in the function.
10040
10041Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8a36672b 10042the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
d604bca3
MH
10043floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10044
10045There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10046you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10047
7bb1ad93
GK
10048@node PCH Target
10049@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10050@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10051
0678ade0 10052@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
914d25dc
JR
10053This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10054@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
0678ade0 10055@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7bb1ad93
GK
10056@end deftypefn
10057
b6fd8800 10058@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8d932be3
RS
10059This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10060compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10061if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10062be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10063
10064@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10065when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10066It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10067compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10068
10069The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10070suitable for most targets.
10071@end deftypefn
10072
b6fd8800 10073@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8d932be3
RS
10074If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10075@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10076of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10077@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10078value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7bb1ad93
GK
10079@end deftypefn
10080
e32ea2d1
RS
10081@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10082Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10083garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10084it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10085to do anything here.
10086@end deftypefn
10087
4185ae53
PB
10088@node C++ ABI
10089@section C++ ABI parameters
10090@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10091
10092@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10093Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10094These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10095default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10096@end deftypefn
10097
10098@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
f676971a 10099This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
914d25dc
JR
10100@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10101@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
4185ae53
PB
10102@end deftypefn
10103
46e995e0
PB
10104@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10105This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10106whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10107known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10108@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8a36672b 10109IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
46e995e0
PB
10110@end deftypefn
10111
10112@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10113This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10114array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10115@end deftypefn
10116
38f8b050 10117@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
d59c7b4b
NC
10118If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10119class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
78466c0e 10120will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
d59c7b4b
NC
10121to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10122modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10123backend's targeted operating system.
10124@end deftypefn
10125
44d10c10
PB
10126@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10127This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10128the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10129@code{false}.
10130@end deftypefn
10131
af287697
MM
10132@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10133This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10134which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10135table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10136Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10137the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10138some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10139method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10140@end deftypefn
10141
1e731102 10142@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 10143@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
1e731102
MM
10144@end deftypefn
10145
10146@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10147This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10148similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10149external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10150classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10151unit will not be COMDAT.
505970fc
MM
10152@end deftypefn
10153
157600d0
GK
10154@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10155This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10156the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10157be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10158@end deftypefn
10159
9f62c3e3
PB
10160@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10161This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10162should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10163is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10164@end deftypefn
10165
97388150
DS
10166@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10167This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10168in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10169destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10170shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10171unloaded. The default is to return false.
10172@end deftypefn
10173
43d9ad1d 10174@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
38f8b050 10175@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
43d9ad1d
DS
10176@end deftypefn
10177
5b880ea6
RO
10178@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10179Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10180@end deftypefn
10181
09e881c9
BE
10182@node Named Address Spaces
10183@section Adding support for named address spaces
10184@cindex named address spaces
10185
10186The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10187standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10188support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10189processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10190GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10191address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10192spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10193@code{const} type attributes.
10194
02a9370c 10195Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
09e881c9
BE
10196pointers to the generic address space.
10197
10198For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10199to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10200processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10201issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10202local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10203address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10204@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10205always 32 bits).
10206
10207Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10208range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10209address space.
10210
3ef0694c
UW
10211To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10212the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10213the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10214named address space #1:
36c5e70a
BE
10215@smallexample
10216#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
3ef0694c 10217c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
36c5e70a 10218@end smallexample
36c5e70a 10219
d4ebfa65
BE
10220@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10221Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10222@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10223The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10224generic address space only.
10225@end deftypefn
10226
10227@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10228Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10229@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10230The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10231generic address space only.
10232@end deftypefn
10233
10234@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10235Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10236with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10237hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10238except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10239version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10240@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10241target hooks for the given address space.
10242@end deftypefn
10243
b6fd8800 10244@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10245Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10246@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10247parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10248finished. This target hook is the same as the
10249@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10250explicit named address space support.
10251@end deftypefn
10252
b6fd8800 10253@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10254Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10255with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10256hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10257except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10258@end deftypefn
10259
b5bcaa4a 10260@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
09e881c9
BE
10261Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10262contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10263a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10264will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10265arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
a4ce9883 10266converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
09e881c9
BE
10267@end deftypefn
10268
b6fd8800 10269@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
09e881c9
BE
10270Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10271@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10272space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10273to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10274guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10275as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10276@end deftypefn
10277
feca2ed3
JW
10278@node Misc
10279@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10280@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10281
10282@c prevent bad page break with this line
10283Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10284
e543e219
ZW
10285@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10286Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10287has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10288conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10289blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10290set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10291to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10292@end defmac
10293
10294@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10295Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10296has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10297conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10298blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10299set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10300to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
a2c4f8e0 10301@end defmac
8fe0ca0c 10302
a2c4f8e0 10303@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
feca2ed3
JW
10304An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10305elements of a jump-table should have.
a2c4f8e0 10306@end defmac
feca2ed3 10307
a2c4f8e0 10308@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
33f7f353
JR
10309Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10310when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10311it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
4226378a 10312To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
33f7f353 10313make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
391aaa6b 10314The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
33f7f353 10315flags can be updated.
a2c4f8e0 10316@end defmac
33f7f353 10317
a2c4f8e0 10318@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
18543a22 10319Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9c49953c
KH
10320should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10321jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10322contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10323is in effect.
a2c4f8e0 10324@end defmac
feca2ed3 10325
b6fd8800 10326@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
e6ff3083 10327This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
feca2ed3
JW
10328is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10329The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10330five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
e6ff3083 10331@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 10332
a2c4f8e0 10333@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
feca2ed3
JW
10334Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10335smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10336Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
a2c4f8e0 10337@end defmac
feca2ed3 10338
7be4d808 10339@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
feca2ed3 10340Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7be4d808
R
10341memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10342bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
feca2ed3 10343zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7be4d808 10344of @var{mem_mode} for which the
feca2ed3 10345insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
f822d252 10346@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
feca2ed3 10347
7be4d808 10348This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
feca2ed3
JW
10349greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10350value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
f822d252 10351@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
feca2ed3 10352define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7be4d808 10353
f822d252 10354You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7be4d808
R
10355the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10356of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10357when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10358integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10359
f822d252 10360You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7be4d808
R
10361mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10362@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10363is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
a2c4f8e0 10364@end defmac
feca2ed3 10365
a2c4f8e0 10366@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
77643ab8
MM
10367Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10368extends.
a2c4f8e0 10369@end defmac
77643ab8 10370
728d406c 10371@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
bc23502b
PB
10372When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10373divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10374the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10375that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10376of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10377has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10378@end deftypefn
10379
a2c4f8e0 10380@defmac MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10381The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10382between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
a2c4f8e0 10383@end defmac
feca2ed3 10384
a2c4f8e0 10385@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10386The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10387between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10388is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10389constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10390at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 10391@end defmac
feca2ed3 10392
a2c4f8e0 10393@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
feca2ed3
JW
10394A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10395actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10396of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
df2a54e9 10397this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
feca2ed3
JW
10398a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10399truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
c771326b 10400instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
feca2ed3
JW
10401include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10402also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
c771326b 10403arguments to bit-field instructions.
feca2ed3
JW
10404
10405If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
c771326b 10406position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
feca2ed3
JW
10407instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10408
10409However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10410only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
c771326b 10411bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
feca2ed3
JW
10412such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10413the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10414
10415You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
a2c4f8e0 10416@end defmac
feca2ed3 10417
273a2526 10418@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
914d25dc 10419@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
273a2526
RS
10420This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10421deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10422@xref{shift patterns}.
10423
10424On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10425shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10426equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10427this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10428otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10429particular behavior is guaranteed.
10430
10431Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10432@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10433that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10434
10435The default implementation of this function returns
10436@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10437and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10438@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10439nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10440by overriding it.
10441@end deftypefn
10442
a2c4f8e0 10443@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
feca2ed3
JW
10444A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10445``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10446bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10447operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10448
10449On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10450
10451@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10452@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10453When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10454modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10455If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10456such cases may improve things.
a2c4f8e0 10457@end defmac
feca2ed3 10458
b12cbf2c 10459@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
66a4ad37 10460The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
b12cbf2c
AN
10461are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10462@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10463sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10464otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10465representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10466@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10467@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
914d25dc 10468@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
b12cbf2c
AN
10469widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10470
10471Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10472value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10473as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10474@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10475
10476Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10477describe two related properties. If you define
10478@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10479to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10480extension.
10481
10482In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10483@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10484@code{mode}.
10485@end deftypefn
10486
a2c4f8e0 10487@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
feca2ed3
JW
10488A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10489with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
ac5eda13
PB
10490(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10491apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
feca2ed3
JW
10492comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10493
630d3d5a
JM
10494A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10495comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
feca2ed3
JW
10496and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10497which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10498true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10499operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
ac5eda13 10500@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
feca2ed3
JW
10501@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10502the compiler.
10503
630d3d5a 10504If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
feca2ed3
JW
10505generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10506replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10507the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10508For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10509@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10510@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10511expression
10512
10513@smallexample
10514(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10515@end smallexample
10516
10517@noindent
10518can be converted to
10519
10520@smallexample
10521(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10522@end smallexample
10523
10524@noindent
10525where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10526tested into the sign bit.
10527
10528There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10529for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10530but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
a3a15b4d 10531are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
feca2ed3 10532perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
b11cc610 10533comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
feca2ed3
JW
10534
10535Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10536from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10537choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10538to be used:
10539
10540@itemize @bullet
10541@item
10542Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10543@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10544``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10545comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10546combine the normalization with other operations.
10547
10548@item
630d3d5a 10549For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
feca2ed3
JW
10550slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10551other machines.
10552
10553@item
10554As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10555exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10556others.
10557
10558@item
10559Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10560@end itemize
10561
10562Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10563@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10564instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10565those cases, e.g., one matching
10566
10567@smallexample
10568(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10569@end smallexample
10570
10571Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10572condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
ac5eda13 10573@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
feca2ed3
JW
10574machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10575and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10576@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10577@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
feca2ed3
JW
10578find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10579
06f31100
RS
10580If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10581not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10582instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
a2c4f8e0 10583@end defmac
feca2ed3 10584
a2c4f8e0 10585@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
df2a54e9 10586A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
feca2ed3 10587returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
fc7ca5fd 10588Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
feca2ed3
JW
10589floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10590this macro.
a2c4f8e0 10591@end defmac
feca2ed3 10592
fc7ca5fd 10593@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
a4d05547 10594A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
fc7ca5fd
RS
10595for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10596mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10597this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10598return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10599this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10600@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10601the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10602given mode.
10603@end defmac
10604
a2c4f8e0
ZW
10605@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10606@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
14670a74 10607A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10608for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
14670a74
SL
10609A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10610If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10611evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10612entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10613the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
14670a74 10614In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10615this value.
14670a74
SL
10616
10617If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10618@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7dba8395
RH
10619
10620This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10621relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
14670a74
SL
10622is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10623to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7dba8395
RH
10624
10625Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10626and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10627visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10628to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8a36672b 10629breaking the API@.
a2c4f8e0 10630@end defmac
7dba8395 10631
a2c4f8e0 10632@defmac Pmode
feca2ed3
JW
10633An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10634this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10635pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10636On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10637modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10638
10639The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10640@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10641@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10642to @code{Pmode}.
a2c4f8e0 10643@end defmac
feca2ed3 10644
a2c4f8e0 10645@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
feca2ed3 10646An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
f71e957e 10647being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10648where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
f71e957e
DK
10649@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10650size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10651as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
a2c4f8e0 10652@end defmac
feca2ed3 10653
a2c4f8e0 10654@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
ee773fcc
NB
10655In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10656constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10657hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10658where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10659strict conformance to the C Standard.
10660
10661Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10662convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10663files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
a2c4f8e0 10664@end defmac
ee773fcc 10665
1efcb8c6
JM
10666@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10667Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10668
10669 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10670@end deftypefn
10671
a2c4f8e0 10672@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
161d7b59 10673Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
feca2ed3
JW
10674This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10675C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10676@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
a2c4f8e0 10677@end defmac
feca2ed3 10678
feca2ed3
JW
10679@findex #pragma
10680@findex pragma
a2c4f8e0 10681@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8b97c5f8 10682Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
a5da89c6 10683If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
b5b3e36a
DJ
10684@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10685for each pragma. The macro may also do any
a5da89c6 10686setup required for the pragmas.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10687
10688The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10689other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
161d7b59 10690definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
feca2ed3 10691
c237e94a 10692If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
91d231cb 10693defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
f09db6e0 10694
8b97c5f8
ZW
10695Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10696@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
630d3d5a 10697silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
a2c4f8e0 10698@end defmac
8b97c5f8 10699
c58b209a 10700@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
b5b3e36a 10701@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8b97c5f8 10702
b5b3e36a
DJ
10703Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10704@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8b97c5f8
ZW
10705@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10706pragma of the form
10707
10708@smallexample
10709#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10710@end smallexample
10711
a5da89c6
NB
10712@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10713@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10714routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
51fabca5 10715on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
75ce3d48 10716@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
51fabca5 10717callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
b5b3e36a
DJ
10718a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10719arguments of pragmas registered with
10720@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10721pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8b97c5f8 10722
75ce3d48 10723Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
aac69a49 10724compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
75ce3d48 10725other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
aac69a49 10726to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
c771326b 10727building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
aac69a49 10728variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
aee96fe9 10729target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
aac69a49 10730the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
75ce3d48 10731code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
aac69a49
NC
10732rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10733how to build this object file.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10734@end deftypefun
10735
b5b3e36a 10736@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10737Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
b5b3e36a
DJ
10738arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10739@end defmac
10740
467cecf3
JB
10741@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10742If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
0bdcd332 10743the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8b7d4300 10744This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
467cecf3
JB
10745@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10746@end defmac
10747
a2c4f8e0 10748@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
b1822ccc 10749Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
170ea7b9 10750identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
b1822ccc
NB
10751not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10752there is no need to define this macro in that case.
a2c4f8e0 10753@end defmac
feca2ed3 10754
a2c4f8e0 10755@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10756Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10757delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10758even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
a3a15b4d 10759@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
feca2ed3
JW
10760every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10761or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10762you should define this macro.
10763
10764You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10765@end defmac
feca2ed3 10766
a2c4f8e0 10767@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10768Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10769delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10770even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10771@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10772some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10773are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10774define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10775instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10776slot of @var{insn}.
10777
10778You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10779@end defmac
feca2ed3 10780
a2c4f8e0 10781@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
15072eb1
ZW
10782Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10783global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10784symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10785instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10786from shared libraries (DLLs).
10787
10788You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
a2c4f8e0 10789@end defmac
861bb6c1 10790
61158923 10791@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
67dfe110 10792This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
61158923 10793any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
67dfe110 10794It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
61158923
HPN
10795clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10796corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10797clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
91b4415a 10798@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
61158923 10799for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
67dfe110 10800@end deftypefn
57bcb97a 10801
a2c4f8e0 10802@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
71d718e0 10803Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10804in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10805@samp{""} if the target does not have a
71d718e0
JM
10806separate math library.
10807
d9d16a19 10808You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10809@end defmac
512b62fb 10810
a2c4f8e0 10811@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
512b62fb
JM
10812Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10813specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10814
10815You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10816is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10817@end defmac
e09d24ff 10818
4969c0d8
L
10819@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10820Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10821functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10822Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
e09d24ff 10823to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
4969c0d8 10824if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
709a840a 10825for cross-profiling.
a2c4f8e0 10826@end defmac
0c99ec5c 10827
a2c4f8e0 10828@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
0c99ec5c
RH
10829
10830A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10831conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10832@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
108331 if it does use cc0.
a2c4f8e0 10834@end defmac
90280148 10835
a2c4f8e0 10836@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10837Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10838conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10839@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10840contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10841and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10842then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10843@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
a2c4f8e0 10844@end defmac
c05ffc49 10845
a2c4f8e0 10846@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10847Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10848if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10849@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10850being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
a2c4f8e0 10851@end defmac
90280148 10852
a2c4f8e0 10853@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
c05ffc49
BS
10854A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10855be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10856a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10857about the currently processed blocks.
a2c4f8e0 10858@end defmac
90280148 10859
a2c4f8e0 10860@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10861A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10862converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10863can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10864to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10865@end defmac
90280148 10866
a2c4f8e0 10867@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10868A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10869converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10870can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10871to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10872@end defmac
c05ffc49 10873
67a0732f
SB
10874@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10875A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10876of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10877to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10878@end defmac
c05ffc49 10879
b6fd8800 10880@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
18dbd950
RS
10881If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10882instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10883just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10884
10885The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10886it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10887laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10888Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10889
10890You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10891definition is null.
10892@end deftypefn
10893
b6fd8800 10894@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
f6155fda
SS
10895Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10896that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
4a1d48f6
BS
10897necessary setup.
10898
c771326b 10899Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
4a1d48f6
BS
10900instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10901they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10902instructions or prefetch instructions).
10903
6e34d3a3
JM
10904To create a built-in function, call the function
10905@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
c771326b 10906which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10907up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
c237e94a 10908only language front ends that use those two functions will call
f6155fda 10909@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
acdcefcc 10910@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10911
914d25dc 10912@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
e9e4b3a8
RG
10913Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10914that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10915builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10916If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10917if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10918If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10919@code{error_mark_node}.
10920@end deftypefn
10921
f6155fda 10922@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
4a1d48f6 10923
c771326b 10924Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
f6155fda
SS
10925@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10926function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10927convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10928@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10929@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10930ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10931built-in function.
acdcefcc 10932@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 10933
7a241624 10934@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
4268e4cf
PB
10935Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10936was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10937@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10938implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10939declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10940arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10941complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10942another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
7a241624 10943@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
4268e4cf
PB
10944@end deftypefn
10945
f311c3b4 10946@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
a05a80fc
KH
10947Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10948@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
f311c3b4
NF
10949built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10950the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10951The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10952call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
d6c2b67d
PB
10953@end deftypefn
10954
72392b81 10955@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
a71a498d 10956
e7e64a25 10957Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
72392b81
JR
10958low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10959could not be applied.
a71a498d 10960
e7e64a25
AS
10961Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10962instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
083cad55 10963the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
a71a498d 10964By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
083cad55 10965loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
a71a498d
AS
10966@end deftypefn
10967
78e4f1ad
UB
10968@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
10969Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10970@end deftypefn
10971
a2c4f8e0 10972@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
6e7b03e1 10973
4fe9b91c 10974Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
6e7b03e1
AH
10975Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10976@var{branch2} is possible.
10977
10978On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10979filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10980may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
a2c4f8e0 10981@end defmac
6e7b03e1 10982
4b4de898
JR
10983@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
10984FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
10985@end deftypefn
10986
914d25dc 10987@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
8ddf681a
R
10988This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10989Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
0ee2ea09 10990PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
8ddf681a
R
10991of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10992@end deftypefn
10993
b48f503c 10994@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
385b6e2d
R
10995
10996When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
4fe9b91c 10997register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
385b6e2d 10998to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
b48f503c
KK
10999it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11000is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11001that had its initial value copied by using
385b6e2d
R
11002@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11003Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11004to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11005the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11006@code{MEM}.
11007If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11008it might decide to use another register anyways.
29454ff5
SL
11009You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11010@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
385b6e2d 11011register in question will not be clobbered.
b48f503c
KK
11012The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11013allocation.
11014@end deftypefn
385b6e2d 11015
215b063c
PB
11016@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11017This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11018@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11019this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11020@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11021to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11022passed along.
11023@end deftypefn
11024
db2960f4 11025@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
ff2ce160 11026The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
db2960f4
SL
11027context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11028the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11029per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11030attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11031The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11032and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11033and is returning to processing at the top level.
11034The default hook function does nothing.
11035
11036GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11037some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11038situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11039or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
914d25dc
JR
11040@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11041outside of any function scope.
db2960f4
SL
11042@end deftypefn
11043
a2c4f8e0 11044@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11045Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11046files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11047use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
a2c4f8e0 11048@end defmac
807633e5 11049
a2c4f8e0 11050@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11051Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11052automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11053do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11054executable files.
a2c4f8e0 11055@end defmac
807633e5 11056
a2c4f8e0 11057@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
807633e5
ZW
11058If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11059specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11060Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11061object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11062lists.
a2c4f8e0 11063@end defmac
807633e5 11064
a2c4f8e0 11065@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
55ae46b1
RM
11066Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11067method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11068must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
95fef11f 11069For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
55ae46b1
RM
11070the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11071defined as this expression:
11072
11073@smallexample
11074build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11075 build_tree_list
11076 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11077 NULL))
11078@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 11079@end defmac
e4ec2cac
AO
11080
11081@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11082This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11083instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11084every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11085reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11086
11087@smallexample
11088static bool
11089cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11090@{
11091 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11092@}
11093@end smallexample
11094@end deftypefn
fe3ad572 11095
a87cf97e 11096@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
fe3ad572
SC
11097This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11098optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c0cbdbd9 11099usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
fe3ad572
SC
11100re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11101to inter-block scheduling.
11102@end deftypefn
11103
11104@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11105Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11106registers
11107that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11108returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11109that all target registers in the class returned by
11110@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11111saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11112epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11113true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11114to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11115to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11116@end deftypefn
2082e02f 11117
2929029c
WG
11118@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11119This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11120This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11121modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11122@end deftypefn
11123
40ac4f73
CB
11124@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11125This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11126should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11127the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11128the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11129is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11130number of memory accesses.
11131@end deftypefn
11132
2082e02f 11133@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
73774972 11134If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
2082e02f
RS
11135that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11136that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11137constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11138more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11139system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11140The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11141@end defmac
94d1613b 11142
3dd53121 11143@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
94d1613b
MS
11144This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11145target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
3dd53121
AP
11146are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11147The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11148@end deftypefn
11149
11150@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11151This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11152target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11153indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11154@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11155@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
94d1613b
MS
11156@end deftypefn
11157
11158@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11159This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11160The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11161systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11162that are different from @option{-I}.
11163@end deftypefn
4a77e08c 11164
914d25dc
JR
11165@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11166This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
4a77e08c 11167for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
914d25dc 11168@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
431ae0bf 11169functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
4a77e08c 11170@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
914d25dc 11171@end defmac
a2bec818
DJ
11172
11173@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11174If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11175target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11176option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11177@end defmac
11178
11179@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11180If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11181@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11182@end defmac
e50e6b88 11183
6590fc9f
KT
11184@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11185If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11186target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11187default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11188@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11189@end defmac
11190
11191@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11192If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11193@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11194@end defmac
11195
94564826
KT
11196@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11197If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11198routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11199and scanf formatter settings.
11200@end defmac
11201
914d25dc 11202@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
445cf5eb
JM
11203If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11204guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11205main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11206important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11207many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11208``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11209and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 11210@end deftypevr
445cf5eb 11211
b6fd8800 11212@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
083cad55
EC
11213If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11214illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
4d3e6fae
FJ
11215with prototype @var{typelist}.
11216@end deftypefn
11217
b6fd8800 11218@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
4de67c26
JM
11219If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11220invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11221if validity should be determined by the front end.
11222@end deftypefn
11223
b6fd8800 11224@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
4de67c26
JM
11225If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11226invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11227@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11228if validity should be determined by the front end.
11229@end deftypefn
11230
b6fd8800 11231@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4de67c26
JM
11232If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11233invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11234and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11235the front end.
11236@end deftypefn
11237
b6fd8800 11238@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11239If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11240invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11241or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11242the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11243@end deftypefn
11244
b6fd8800 11245@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11246If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11247invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11248or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11249the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11250@end deftypefn
11251
b6fd8800 11252@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
ff2ce160
MS
11253If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11254@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
40449a90
SL
11255analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11256front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11257target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11258This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11259@end deftypefn
11260
b6fd8800 11261@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
ff2ce160
MS
11262If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11263@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
40449a90 11264or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11265This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
40449a90
SL
11266conversion rules.
11267This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11268@end deftypefn
11269
e50e6b88
DS
11270@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11271This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11272classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11273SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11274@end defmac
64ee9490
EC
11275
11276@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11277This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11278NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11279@end defmac
56e449d3
SL
11280
11281@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11282Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11283to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
56e449d3
SL
11284call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11285and the associated definitions of those functions.
11286@end defmac
007e61c2 11287
2e3f842f
L
11288@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11289Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11290necessary.
11291@end deftypefn
11292
11293@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
914d25dc 11294This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
2e3f842f 11295different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
914d25dc
JR
11296argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11297is needed.
2e3f842f
L
11298@end deftypefn
11299
b6fd8800 11300@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
007e61c2
PB
11301When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11302arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11303stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11304debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11305@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11306cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11307to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11308false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11309@end deftypefn
2c5bfdf7 11310
2c5bfdf7
AN
11311@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11312On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11313a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11314is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11315is computed from this register using immediate addition or
a4ce9883 11316subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
2c5bfdf7
AN
11317the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11318available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11319constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11320down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11321@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11322accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11323value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11324MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11325@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11326is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11327
5dcfdccd
KY
11328@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11329Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11330memory model bits are allowed.
11331@end deftypefn
11332
57c5ab1b
RH
11333@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11334This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11335@end deftypevr